blob: c6eed082e8739519d11bef58d6936cd0a6750f21 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200459 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200460 - noepoll
461 - nokqueue
462 - nopoll
463 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200468 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100469 - tune.maxaccept
470 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200471 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200472 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100473 - tune.rcvbuf.client
474 - tune.rcvbuf.server
475 - tune.sndbuf.client
476 - tune.sndbuf.server
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100477 - tune.zlib.memlevel
478 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100479
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200480 * Debugging
481 - debug
482 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200483
484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004853.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200486------------------------------------
487
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200488ca-base <dir>
489 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200490 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
491 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493chroot <jail dir>
494 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
495 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
496 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
497 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
498 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
499 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501crt-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
503 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
504 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506daemon
507 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
508 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
509 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
510
511gid <number>
512 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
513 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
514 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
515 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517group <group name>
518 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
519 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100520
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200521log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
523 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100524 configured with "log global".
525
526 <address> can be one of:
527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100528 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100529 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
530 port).
531
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100532 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
533 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
534 port).
535
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100536 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
537 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
538 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
539 writeable).
540
541 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542
543 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
544 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
545 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
546
547 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200548 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
549 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
550 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
551 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
552 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
553 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200555 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100557log-send-hostname [<string>]
558 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
559 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
560 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
561 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
562 the logs.
563
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000564log-tag <string>
565 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
566 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
567 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
568 running on the same host.
569
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570nbproc <number>
571 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
572 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
573 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
574 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
575 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
576
577pidfile <pidfile>
578 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
579 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
580 starting the process. See also "daemon".
581
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200582stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
583 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
584 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
585 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
586 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
587 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
588 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
589 the number of processes used.
590
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200591stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
592 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
593 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
594 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
595 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200596
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200597 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
598 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
599 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200600
601stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
602 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
603 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100604 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605
606stats maxconn <connections>
607 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
608 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
609
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610uid <number>
611 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
612 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
613 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
614 one. See also "gid" and "user".
615
616ulimit-n <number>
617 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
618 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
619 option.
620
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100621unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
622 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
623
624 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
625 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
626 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
627 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
628 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
629 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
630 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
631 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
632 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
633 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635user <user name>
636 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
637 See also "uid" and "group".
638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200639node <name>
640 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
641
642 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
643 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
644 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
645 traffic.
646
647description <text>
648 Add a text that describes the instance.
649
650 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
651 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
652 "<" and ">" characters.
653
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006553.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656-----------------------
657
658maxconn <number>
659 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
660 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
661 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
662 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
663
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200664maxconnrate <number>
665 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
666 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
667 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
668 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
669 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
670 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
671 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
672 fairness.
673
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100674maxpipes <number>
675 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
676 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
677 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
678 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
679 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
680 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
681
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200682maxsslconn <number>
683 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
684 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
685 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
686 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
687 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
688 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
689 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
690
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100691maxzlibmem <number>
692 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
693 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
694 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
695 The default value is 0.
696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697noepoll
698 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
699 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
700 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
701
702nokqueue
703 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
704 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
705 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
706
707nopoll
708 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
709 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100710 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
712 "nokqueue".
713
714nosepoll
715 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
716 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
717 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
718
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100719nosplice
720 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
721 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
722 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100723 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100724 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
725 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
726 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
727 "option splice-response".
728
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200729spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
730 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
731 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
732 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
733 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
734 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
735
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200736tune.bufsize <number>
737 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
738 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
739 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
740 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
741 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
742 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
743 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
744 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400745 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
746 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
747 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200748
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200749tune.chksize <number>
750 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
751 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
752 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
753 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
754 checks whenever possible.
755
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200756tune.http.maxhdr <number>
757 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
758 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
759 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
760 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
761 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
762 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
763 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
764 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
765 limit too high.
766
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100767tune.maxaccept <number>
768 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
769 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
770 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100771 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100772 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
773 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100774 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100775 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
776
777tune.maxpollevents <number>
778 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
779 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
780 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
781 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
782 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
783
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200784tune.maxrewrite <number>
785 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
786 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
787 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
788 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
789 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
790 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
791 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
792 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
793 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
794 bufsize.
795
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200796tune.pipesize <number>
797 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
798 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
799 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
800 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
801 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
802 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
803
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100804tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
805tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
806 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
807 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
808 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
809 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
810 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
811 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
812 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
813
814tune.sndbuf.client <number>
815tune.sndbuf.server <number>
816 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
817 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
818 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
819 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
820 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
821 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
822 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
823 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
824 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
825 notifying haproxy again.
826
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100827tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
828 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
829 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
830 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
831 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
832 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
833
834tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
835 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
836 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
837 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
838 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008403.3. Debugging
841--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842
843debug
844 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
845 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
846 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
847 system startup.
848
849quiet
850 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
851 line argument "-q".
852
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008543.4. Userlists
855--------------
856It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
857http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
858it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
859
860userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100861 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100862 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
863
864group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100865 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100866 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
867 proceeded by "users" keyword.
868
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100869user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
870 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100871 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
872 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100873 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
874 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100875 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
876 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
877
878
879 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100880 userlist L1
881 group G1 users tiger,scott
882 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100883
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100884 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
885 user scott insecure-password elgato
886 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100887
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100888 userlist L2
889 group G1
890 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100891
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100892 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
893 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
894 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100895
896 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200897
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200898
8993.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200900----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
902haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
903pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
904identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
905or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
906Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
907known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
908the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
909process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
910during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
911tables.
912
913peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400914 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200915 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
916
917peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
918 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
919 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
920 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
921 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
922 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
923 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
924
925 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
926 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
927
928 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
929 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
930 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
931 across all peers.
932
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200933 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200934 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100935 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
936 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
937 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200938
939 backend mybackend
940 mode tcp
941 balance roundrobin
942 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
943 stick on src
944
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100945 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
946 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200947
948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009494. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200950----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
953 - defaults <name>
954 - frontend <name>
955 - backend <name>
956 - listen <name>
957
958A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
959its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
960section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100961section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962
963A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
964connections.
965
966A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
967to forward incoming connections.
968
969A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
970parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100972All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
973'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
974case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
975
976Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
977logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
978proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
979However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
980name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
981
982Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
983and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100984bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100985protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
986modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
987arbitrary criteria.
988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009904.1. Proxy keywords matrix
991--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200993The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
994limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
995they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
996limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200999and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1000with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1001specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001002
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1005------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1006acl - X X X
1007appsession - - X X
1008backlog X X X -
1009balance X - X X
1010bind - X X -
1011bind-process X X X X
1012block - X X X
1013capture cookie - X X -
1014capture request header - X X -
1015capture response header - X X -
1016clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001017compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001018contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1019cookie X - X X
1020default-server X - X X
1021default_backend X X X -
1022description - X X X
1023disabled X X X X
1024dispatch - - X X
1025enabled X X X X
1026errorfile X X X X
1027errorloc X X X X
1028errorloc302 X X X X
1029-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1030errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001031force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001032fullconn X - X X
1033grace X X X X
1034hash-type X - X X
1035http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001036http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001037http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001038http-request - X X X
1039id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001040ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001041log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001042maxconn X X X -
1043mode X X X X
1044monitor fail - X X -
1045monitor-net X X X -
1046monitor-uri X X X -
1047option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1048option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1049option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1050option allbackups (*) X - X X
1051option checkcache (*) X - X X
1052option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1053option contstats (*) X X X -
1054option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1055option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1056option forceclose (*) X X X X
1057-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1058option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001059option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001060option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001061option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1062option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1063option httpchk X - X X
1064option httpclose (*) X X X X
1065option httplog X X X X
1066option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001067option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001068option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001069option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1070option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1071option logasap (*) X X X -
1072option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001073option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001074option nolinger (*) X X X X
1075option originalto X X X X
1076option persist (*) X - X X
1077option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001078option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001079option smtpchk X - X X
1080option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1081option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1082option splice-request (*) X X X X
1083option splice-response (*) X X X X
1084option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1085option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1086-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1087option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1088option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1089option tcpka X X X X
1090option tcplog X X X X
1091option transparent (*) X - X X
1092persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1093rate-limit sessions X X X -
1094redirect - X X X
1095redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1096redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1097reqadd - X X X
1098reqallow - X X X
1099reqdel - X X X
1100reqdeny - X X X
1101reqiallow - X X X
1102reqidel - X X X
1103reqideny - X X X
1104reqipass - X X X
1105reqirep - X X X
1106reqisetbe - X X X
1107reqitarpit - X X X
1108reqpass - X X X
1109reqrep - X X X
1110-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1111reqsetbe - X X X
1112reqtarpit - X X X
1113retries X - X X
1114rspadd - X X X
1115rspdel - X X X
1116rspdeny - X X X
1117rspidel - X X X
1118rspideny - X X X
1119rspirep - X X X
1120rsprep - X X X
1121server - - X X
1122source X - X X
1123srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001124stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001125stats auth X - X X
1126stats enable X - X X
1127stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001128stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001129stats realm X - X X
1130stats refresh X - X X
1131stats scope X - X X
1132stats show-desc X - X X
1133stats show-legends X - X X
1134stats show-node X - X X
1135stats uri X - X X
1136-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1137stick match - - X X
1138stick on - - X X
1139stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001140stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001141stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001142tcp-request connection - X X -
1143tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001144tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001145tcp-response content - - X X
1146tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001147timeout check X - X X
1148timeout client X X X -
1149timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1150timeout connect X - X X
1151timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1152timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1153timeout http-request X X X X
1154timeout queue X - X X
1155timeout server X - X X
1156timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1157timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001158timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001159transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001160unique-id-format X X X -
1161unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001162use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001163use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001164------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1165 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011684.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1169---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001170
1171This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1172
1173
1174acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1175 Declare or complete an access list.
1176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1177 no | yes | yes | yes
1178 Example:
1179 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1180 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1181 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001183 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001184
1185
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001186appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1187 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001188 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1190 no | no | yes | yes
1191 Arguments :
1192 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1193 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1194
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001195 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001196 checked in each cookie value.
1197
1198 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1199 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1200 milliseconds.
1201
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001202 request-learn
1203 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1204 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1205 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1206 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1207 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1208 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1209
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001210 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1211 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1212 data following this prefix.
1213
1214 Example :
1215 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1216
1217 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1218 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1219
1220 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1221 2 modes are currently supported :
1222 - path-parameters :
1223 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1224 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1225 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1226 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1227 - query-string :
1228 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1229 query string.
1230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001231 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1232 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1233 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1234 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001235 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1236 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1237 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001238 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1239 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1240
1241 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1242
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001243 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1244 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1245 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001247 Example :
1248 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1249
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001250 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1251 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001252
1253
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001254backlog <conns>
1255 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1257 yes | yes | yes | no
1258 Arguments :
1259 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1260 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001261 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001262
1263 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1264 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1265 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1266 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1267 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1268 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1269 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1270 backlog parameter.
1271
1272 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1273 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1274 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1275
1276 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1277
1278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001279balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001280balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001281 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1283 yes | no | yes | yes
1284 Arguments :
1285 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1286 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1287 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1288 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1289
1290 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1291 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1292 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1293 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001294 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1295 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1296 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1297 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1298 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1299 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1300 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1301 it, so that you don't worry.
1302
1303 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1304 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1305 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1306 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1307 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1308 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1309 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1310 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001311
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001312 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1313 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1314 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1315 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1316 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1317 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1318 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1319 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1320
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001321 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1322 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1323 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1324 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001325 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001326 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1327 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1328 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1329 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1330 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001331 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1332 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1333 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1334 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1335 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1336 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001338 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1339 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1340 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1341 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1342 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1343 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1344 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1345 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001346 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001347 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001348 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1349 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1350 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001351
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001352 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1353 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1354 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1355 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1356 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1357 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1358 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1359 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1360 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1361 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1362 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1363 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001364
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001365 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001366 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1367 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1368 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1369 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1370 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1371 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1372 URIs start with a leading "/".
1373
1374 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1375 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1376 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1377 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001379 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001380 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1381
1382 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001383 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1384 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1385 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1386 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1387 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1388 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1389 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1390 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1391 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1392 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1393 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1394 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1395 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1396 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1397 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1398 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1399 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1400 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1401 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001402
1403 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1404 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1405 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1406 server will receive the request.
1407
1408 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1409 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1410 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1411 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1412 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001413 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1414 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1415 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001417 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1418 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1419 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1420 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1421 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001423 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001424 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1425 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1426 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1427
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001428 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1429 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1430 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1431
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001432 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001433 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001434 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1435 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1436 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1437 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1438 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1439 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001440 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001441 used instead.
1442
1443 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1444 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1445 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1446 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1447
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001448 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1449 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1450 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1451
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001452 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001454 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001455 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1456 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001457
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001458 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001459 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001461 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1462 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1463 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464
1465 Examples :
1466 balance roundrobin
1467 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001468 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001469 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1470 balance hdr(host)
1471 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001472
1473 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1474 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001476 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001477 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1478 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1479 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1480 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1481
1482 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1483 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1484 defaults to 16 kB.
1485
1486 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1487 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1488
1489 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1490 Round Robin.
1491
1492 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1493 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1494 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1495 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1496
1497 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1498
1499 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001500 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001501 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1502 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1503 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001504
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001505 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1506 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001507
1508
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001509bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1510bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001511 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1513 no | yes | yes | no
1514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001515 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1516 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1517 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1518 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001519 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001520
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001521 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1522 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001523 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1524 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1525 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001526 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1527 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1528 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1529 the range.
1530
1531 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1532 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1533 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1534 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1535 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1536 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1537 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001538 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001539 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001541 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1542 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1543 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1544 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1545 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1546 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1547 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1548 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001550 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1551 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1552 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1553 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001554
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1556 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1557 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1558 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1559 in a frontend.
1560
1561 Example :
1562 listen http_proxy
1563 bind :80,:443
1564 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001565 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001567 listen http_https_proxy
1568 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001569 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001570
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001571 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001572 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001575bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1576 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | yes | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1581 may be used to override a default value.
1582
1583 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1584 option may be combined with other numbers.
1585
1586 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1587 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1588 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1589 missing from all processes.
1590
1591 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1592 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1593 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1594 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1595
1596 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1597 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1598 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1599 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1600 and 'even' instances.
1601
1602 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1603 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1604 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1605 32.
1606
1607 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1608 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1609
1610 Example :
1611 listen app_ip1
1612 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001613 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001614
1615 listen app_ip2
1616 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001617 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001618
1619 listen management
1620 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001621 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001622
1623 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1624
1625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626block { if | unless } <condition>
1627 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1629 no | yes | yes | yes
1630
1631 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1632 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001633 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001634 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001635 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1636 "block" statements per instance.
1637
1638 Example:
1639 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1640 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1641 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1642 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001644 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645
1646
1647capture cookie <name> len <length>
1648 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1650 no | yes | yes | no
1651 Arguments :
1652 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1653 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1654 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1655 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1656 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1657
1658 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1659 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1660 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1661 right if it exceeds <length>.
1662
1663 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1664 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1665 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1666 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1667
1668 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1669 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1670 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1671
1672 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1673 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1674 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1675 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001676 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1678
1679 Example:
1680 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1681
1682 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001683 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684
1685
1686capture request header <name> len <length>
1687 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1689 no | yes | yes | no
1690 Arguments :
1691 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001692 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001693 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1694 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1695 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1696
1697 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1698 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1699 it exceeds <length>.
1700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001701 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001702 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1703 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001704 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1705 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1706 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1707 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001709 environments to find where the request came from.
1710
1711 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1712 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1713 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1714 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715
1716 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1717 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1718 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1719 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1720
1721 Example:
1722 capture request header Host len 15
1723 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1724 capture request header Referrer len 15
1725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001726 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727 about logging.
1728
1729
1730capture response header <name> len <length>
1731 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1733 no | yes | yes | no
1734 Arguments :
1735 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001736 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1738 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1739 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1740
1741 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1742 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1743 it exceeds <length>.
1744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001745 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1747 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1748 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001749 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1750 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1751 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1752 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753
1754 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1755 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1756 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1757 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1758
1759 Example:
1760 capture response header Content-length len 9
1761 capture response header Location len 15
1762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001763 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001764 about logging.
1765
1766
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001767clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1770 yes | yes | yes | no
1771 Arguments :
1772 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1773 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1774 as explained at the top of this document.
1775
1776 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1777 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1778 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1779 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1780 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1781 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1782 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1783 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001784 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1786 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1787
1788 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1789 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1790 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1791 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1792 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1793 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1794
1795 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1796 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1797
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001798 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1799 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001801compression algo [ gzip ] ...
1802compression type ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001803compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001804 Enable HTTP compression.
1805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1806 yes | yes | yes | yes
1807 Arguments :
1808 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1809 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001810 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1811
1812 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1813 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1814 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1815 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1816 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1817 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1818 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1819 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1820 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001821
1822 Examples :
1823 compression algo gzip
1824 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001826contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001827 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1829 yes | no | yes | yes
1830 Arguments :
1831 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1833 as explained at the top of this document.
1834
1835 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001836 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001837 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1839 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1840 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1841 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1842
1843 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1844 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1845 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1846 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1847 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1848 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1849
1850 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1851 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1852 instead.
1853
1854 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1855 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1856
1857
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001858cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001859 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1860 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1863 yes | no | yes | yes
1864 Arguments :
1865 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1866 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1867 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1868 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1869 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1870 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1871 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1872 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1873 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1874
1875 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1876 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1877 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1878 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1879 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1880 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1881 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1882 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1883 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1884 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1885 "insert" and "prefix".
1886
1887 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001888 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001889
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001890 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001891 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1892 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1893 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1894 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1895 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1896 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1897 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1898 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1899 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1900 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
1902 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1903 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1904 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1905 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1906 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1907 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1908 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1909 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1910 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1911 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001912 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1913 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1914 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001916 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1917 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1918 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001919 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1920 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1921 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1922 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001923 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1924 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1925 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001926
1927 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1928 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1929 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1930 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1931 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1932 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1933 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1934 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1935 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1936
1937 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1938 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1939 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1940 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1941 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1942 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1943 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1944 persistence cookie in the cache.
1945 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1946
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001947 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1948 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1949 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1950 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1951 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1952 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1953 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1954 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1955 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1956 they logout.
1957
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001958 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1959 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1960 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1961 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1962
1963 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1964 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1965 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1966 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1967 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1968 this attribute.
1969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001970 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001971 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001972 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1973 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1974 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1975 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1976 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1977 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001978
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001979 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1980 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1981 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1982 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1983 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1984 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1985 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1986 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1987 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1988 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1989 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1990 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1991 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1992 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1993 the site.
1994
1995 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1996 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1997 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1998 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1999 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2000 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2001 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2002 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2003 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2004 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2005 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2006 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2007 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2008 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2009 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2010 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2013 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2014 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2015 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017 Examples :
2018 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2019 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2020 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002021 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002022
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002023 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002024 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002027default-server [param*]
2028 Change default options for a server in a backend
2029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2030 yes | no | yes | yes
2031 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002032 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2033 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2034 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2035 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002036
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002037 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002038 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2039
2040 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043default_backend <backend>
2044 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2046 yes | yes | yes | no
2047 Arguments :
2048 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2049
2050 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2051 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2052 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2053 will catch all undetermined requests.
2054
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055 Example :
2056
2057 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2058 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2059 default_backend dynamic
2060
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002061 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
2064disabled
2065 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2067 yes | yes | yes | yes
2068 Arguments : none
2069
2070 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2071 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2072 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2073 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2074 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2075 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2076 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2077
2078 See also : "enabled"
2079
2080
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002081dispatch <address>:<port>
2082 Set a default server address
2083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2084 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002085 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002086
2087 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2088 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2089 during start-up.
2090
2091 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2092 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2093 possible with normal servers.
2094
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002095 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002096 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2097 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2098 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2099 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2100
2101 See also : "server"
2102
2103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104enabled
2105 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2107 yes | yes | yes | yes
2108 Arguments : none
2109
2110 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2111 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2112
2113 See also : "disabled"
2114
2115
2116errorfile <code> <file>
2117 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2119 yes | yes | yes | yes
2120 Arguments :
2121 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002122 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123
2124 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002125 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002127 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2128 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129
2130 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2131 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2132 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2133
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002134 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2137 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2138 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2139 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2140
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002141 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2142 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2143 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2144 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2145 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2146 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2149 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2150 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002151 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002152 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2153
2154 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2155
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002156 Example :
2157 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2158 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2159 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2160
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002161
2162errorloc <code> <url>
2163errorloc302 <code> <url>
2164 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2166 yes | yes | yes | yes
2167 Arguments :
2168 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002169 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002170
2171 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2172 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2173 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2174 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2175 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2176
2177 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2178 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2179 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2180
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002181 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2182
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2184 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2185 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2186 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2187 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2188 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2189 request.
2190
2191 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2192
2193
2194errorloc303 <code> <url>
2195 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2197 yes | yes | yes | yes
2198 Arguments :
2199 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2200 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2201
2202 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2203 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2204 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2205 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2206 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2207
2208 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2209 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2210 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2211
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002212 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2213
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002214 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2215 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2216 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2217 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002218 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002219
2220 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2221
2222
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002223force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2224 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2226 no | yes | yes | yes
2227
2228 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2229 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2230 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2231 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2232 marked down for maintenance operations.
2233
2234 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2235 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2236 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2237 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2238 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2239 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2240 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2241 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2242 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2243
2244 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2245 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2246 is used.
2247
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002248 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002249 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002250
2251
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002252fullconn <conns>
2253 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2255 yes | no | yes | yes
2256 Arguments :
2257 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2258 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2259
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002260 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002261 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002262 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002263 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2264 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2265 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2266 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2267 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002268 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002269
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002270 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2271 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2272 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2273
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002274 Example :
2275 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2276 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2277 # connections.
2278 backend dynamic
2279 fullconn 10000
2280 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2281 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2282
2283 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2284
2285
2286grace <time>
2287 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002289 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002290 Arguments :
2291 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2292 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2293 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2294
2295 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2296 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002297 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002298 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2299
2300 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2301 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2302 simplify it.
2303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002305hash-type <method>
2306 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 yes | no | yes | yes
2309 Arguments :
2310 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2311 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2312 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2313 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2314 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2315 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2316 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2317 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2318 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2319
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002320 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2321 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2322 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2323 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2324 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2325 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2326 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2327 this value.
2328
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002329 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2330 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2331 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2332 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2333 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2334 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2335 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2336 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2337 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2338 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2339 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2340 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2341 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2342
2343 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2344
2345 See also : "balance", "server"
2346
2347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348http-check disable-on-404
2349 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002351 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 Arguments : none
2353
2354 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2355 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2356 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2357 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2358 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2359 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2360 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2361 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002362 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2363 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2364 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2365
2366 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2367
2368
2369http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002370 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002372 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002373 Arguments :
2374 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2375 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002376 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002377 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2378 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2379 details on the supported keywords.
2380
2381 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2382 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2383 with the usual backslash ('\').
2384
2385 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2386 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2387 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2388 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2389 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2390
2391 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002392 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002393 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2394 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2395 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2396
2397 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002398 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002399 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2400 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2401 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2402 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2403
2404 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002405 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002406 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2407 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2408 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2409 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2410 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2411 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2412 trace).
2413
2414 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002416 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2417 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2418 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2419 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2420 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2421 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2422
2423 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2424 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2425 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2426 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2427 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2428 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2429 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2430 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2431
2432 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2433 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2434
2435 Examples :
2436 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002437 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002438
2439 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002440 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002441
2442 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002443 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002444
2445 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002446 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002448 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002449
2450
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002451http-check send-state
2452 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2454 yes | no | yes | yes
2455 Arguments : none
2456
2457 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2458 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2459 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2460 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2461 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2462
2463 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2464 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2465 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2466 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2467 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2468 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2469 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2470 checked in multiple backends.
2471
2472 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2473 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2474
2475 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2476 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2477 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2478 one fails.
2479
2480 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2481 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2482 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2483
2484 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2485 server's queue.
2486
2487 Example of a header received by the application server :
2488 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2489 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2490
2491 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2492
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002493http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002494 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002495 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2496
2497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 no | yes | yes | yes
2499
2500 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2501 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2502 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002503 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2504 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002505 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2506
2507 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2508 instance.
2509
2510 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002511 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2512 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2513 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002514
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002515 http-request allow if nagios
2516 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2517 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2518 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002519
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002520 Example:
2521 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002522
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002523 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002524
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002525 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2526 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002527
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002528http-send-name-header [<header>]
2529 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2530
2531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2532 yes | no | yes | yes
2533
2534 Arguments :
2535
2536 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2537
2538 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2539 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2540 is added with the header string proved.
2541
2542 See also : "server"
2543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002544id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002545 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2547 no | yes | yes | yes
2548 Arguments : none
2549
2550 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2551 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2552 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002553
2554
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002555ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2556 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2558 no | yes | yes | yes
2559
2560 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2561 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2562 and running).
2563
2564 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2565 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2566 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2567 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2568 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2569
2570 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2571 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2572
2573 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2574 "unless" condition is met.
2575
2576 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2577
2578
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002579log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002580log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002581no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002582 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2584 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002585
2586 Prefix :
2587 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2588 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2589 prefix does not allow arguments.
2590
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591 Arguments :
2592 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2593 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2594 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2595 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2596 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2597 parameter.
2598
2599 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2600 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2601
2602 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2603 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2604 standard syslog port).
2605
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002606 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2607 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2608 standard syslog port).
2609
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002610 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2611 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2612 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2613 appropriately writeable).
2614
2615 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2616
2617 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2618 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2619 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2620
2621 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2622 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2623 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002624 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2625 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2626 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2627 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2628 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002629
2630 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2631
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002632 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2633 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2634 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002635
2636 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2637 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2638 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2639 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2640
2641 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2642 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002643
2644 Example :
2645 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002646 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2647 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002649log-format <string>
2650 Allows you to custom a log line.
2651
2652 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2653
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002654
2655maxconn <conns>
2656 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2658 yes | yes | yes | no
2659 Arguments :
2660 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2661 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2662 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2663 closes.
2664
2665 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2666 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2667 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2668 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2669 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2670 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2671 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2672 properly tuned.
2673
2674 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2675 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2676 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2677
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002678 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2679
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002680 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2681
2682
2683mode { tcp|http|health }
2684 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2686 yes | yes | yes | yes
2687 Arguments :
2688 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2689 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2690 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2691 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2692
2693 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2694 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2695 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2696 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2697 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2698
2699 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002700 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2701 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2702 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2703 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2704 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2705 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2706 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002707
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002708 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2709 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2710 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002711
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002712 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713 defaults http_instances
2714 mode http
2715
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002716 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002719monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2722 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002723 Arguments :
2724 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2725 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002726 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2728 backend and its backup.
2729
2730 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2731 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2732 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2733 servers in a list of backends.
2734
2735 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2736 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2737 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2738 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2739 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2740 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2741 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002742 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2743 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744
2745 Example:
2746 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002747 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002748 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2749 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2750 monitor-uri /site_alive
2751 monitor fail if site_dead
2752
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002753 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002754
2755
2756monitor-net <source>
2757 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2759 yes | yes | yes | no
2760 Arguments :
2761 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2762 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2763 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2764 followed by a mask.
2765
2766 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2767 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002768 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002769 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2770
2771 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2772 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2773 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2774 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002775 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2776 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2777 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002779 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2780 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2781 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2782 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2783 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2784 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002785
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002786 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2787 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002788
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002789 Example :
2790 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2791 frontend www
2792 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2793
2794 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2795
2796
2797monitor-uri <uri>
2798 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2800 yes | yes | yes | no
2801 Arguments :
2802 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2803 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2804
2805 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2806 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2807 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2808 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2809 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2810 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2811 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2812 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2813
2814 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2815 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2816 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2817 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2818 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2819 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2820
2821 Example :
2822 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2823 frontend www
2824 mode http
2825 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2826
2827 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2828
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002830option abortonclose
2831no option abortonclose
2832 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2834 yes | no | yes | yes
2835 Arguments : none
2836
2837 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2838 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2839 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2840 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002841 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002842 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2843 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2844 encountered while delivering the response.
2845
2846 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2847 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2848 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2849 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2850 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2851 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002852 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002853 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002854 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002855 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2856 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2857 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2858
2859 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2860 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2861 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2862 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2863 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2864 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2865 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2866 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002867 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002868
2869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2871
2872 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2873
2874
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002875option accept-invalid-http-request
2876no option accept-invalid-http-request
2877 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2879 yes | yes | yes | no
2880 Arguments : none
2881
2882 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2883 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2884 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2885 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2886 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2887 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2888 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2889 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002890 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2891 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2892 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2893 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2894 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2895 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002896
2897 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2898 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2899 been confirmed.
2900
2901 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2902 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002903 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2904 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002905 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2906
2907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2909
2910 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2911 stats socket.
2912
2913
2914option accept-invalid-http-response
2915no option accept-invalid-http-response
2916 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2918 yes | no | yes | yes
2919 Arguments : none
2920
2921 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2922 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2923 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2924 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2925 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2926 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2927 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2928 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2929 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2930
2931 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2932 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2933 been confirmed.
2934
2935 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2936 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2937 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2938 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2939
2940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2942
2943 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2944 stats socket.
2945
2946
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002947option allbackups
2948no option allbackups
2949 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | no | yes | yes
2952 Arguments : none
2953
2954 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2955 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2956 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2957 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2958 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2959 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2960 order between the backup servers anymore.
2961
2962 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2963 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2964
2965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2967
2968
2969option checkcache
2970no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002971 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2973 yes | no | yes | yes
2974 Arguments : none
2975
2976 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2977 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002978 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002979 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2980 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002981 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002982
2983 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002984 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002985 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002986 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2987 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002988 to the client are :
2989 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002990 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002991 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002992 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2993 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2994 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2995 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2996 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2997 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2998 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2999 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3000 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3001 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3002 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3003
3004 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003005 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003006 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003007 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003008 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3009
3010 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3011 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003012 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003013 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3014
3015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3017
3018
3019option clitcpka
3020no option clitcpka
3021 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3023 yes | yes | yes | no
3024 Arguments : none
3025
3026 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3027 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3028 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3029 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3030
3031 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3032 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3033 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3034 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3035
3036 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3037 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3038 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3039 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3040 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3041
3042 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3043
3044 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3045 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3046 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3047
3048 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3049 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3050
3051 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3052
3053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054option contstats
3055 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 yes | yes | yes | no
3058 Arguments : none
3059
3060 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3061 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3062 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3063 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3064 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3065 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3066 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3067
3068
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003069option dontlog-normal
3070no option dontlog-normal
3071 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 yes | yes | yes | no
3074 Arguments : none
3075
3076 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3077 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3078 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3079 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3080 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3081 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3082 logged.
3083
3084 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3085 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3086 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003088 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003089 logging.
3090
3091
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003092option dontlognull
3093no option dontlognull
3094 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3096 yes | yes | yes | no
3097 Arguments : none
3098
3099 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3100 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3101 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3102 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3103 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3104 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3105 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3106
3107 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3108 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3109 would not be logged.
3110
3111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003114 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003115
3116
3117option forceclose
3118no option forceclose
3119 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003122 Arguments : none
3123
3124 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3125 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3126 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3127 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3128 global session times in the logs.
3129
3130 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003131 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003132 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3133 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3134 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3135 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003136
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003137 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3138 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3139 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3140
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3143
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003144 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003145
3146
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003147option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003148 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3150 yes | yes | yes | yes
3151 Arguments :
3152 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3153 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003154 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003155 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003156
3157 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3158 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3159 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3160 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3161 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3162 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3163 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003164 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3165 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3166 possible that the client has already brought one.
3167
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003168 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003169 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003170 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3171 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003172 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3173 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003174
3175 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3176 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3177 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3178 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3179 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3180 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3181 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3182
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003183 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3184 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3185 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3186 are under the control of the end-user.
3187
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003188 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003189 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3190 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003191 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3192 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3193 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003194
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003195 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3196 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3197 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3198 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3199 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003200
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003201 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003202 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3203 frontend www
3204 mode http
3205 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3206
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003207 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3208 backend www
3209 mode http
3210 option forwardfor header X-Client
3211
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003212 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3213 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003214
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003215
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003216option http-no-delay
3217no option http-no-delay
3218 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3220 yes | yes | yes | yes
3221 Arguments : none
3222
3223 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3224 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3225 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3226 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3227 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3228 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3229 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3230 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3231 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3232 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3233 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3234 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3235 affected.
3236
3237 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3238 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3239 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3240 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3241 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3242 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3243 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3244 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3245 latency environments.
3246
3247
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003248option http-pretend-keepalive
3249no option http-pretend-keepalive
3250 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3252 yes | yes | yes | yes
3253 Arguments : none
3254
3255 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3256 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3257 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3258 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3259 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3260 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3261 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3262 consider the response complete.
3263
3264 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3265 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3266 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3267 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3268 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3269 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3270
3271 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3272 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3273 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3274 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3275 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3276 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3277 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3278
3279 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3280 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003281 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003282 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3283 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003284
3285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3287
3288 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3289
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003290
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003291option http-server-close
3292no option http-server-close
3293 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3295 yes | yes | yes | yes
3296 Arguments : none
3297
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003298 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3299 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3300 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3301 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3302 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3303 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3304 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3305 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3306 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3307 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3308 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3309 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003310
3311 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3312 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3313 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3314 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003315 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3316 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003317
3318 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3319 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003320 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3321 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3322 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003323
3324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3326
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003327 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3328 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003329
3330
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003331option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003332no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003333 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3335 yes | yes | yes | no
3336 Arguments : none
3337
3338 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3339 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3340 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3341 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3342 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3343 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3344 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3345
3346 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3347 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3348 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3349 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3350 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3351 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3352 request along its whole life.
3353
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003354 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3355 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3356 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3357 front of an existing proxy.
3358
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003359 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3360
3361 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3362 http-server-close".
3363
3364
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003365option httpchk
3366option httpchk <uri>
3367option httpchk <method> <uri>
3368option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3369 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3371 yes | no | yes | yes
3372 Arguments :
3373 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3374 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3375 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3376 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3377 ones.
3378
3379 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3380 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3381 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3382
3383 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3384 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3385 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3386 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3387 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3388
3389 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3390 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3391 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3392 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3393 the lack of any response.
3394
3395 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3396
3397 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3398 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3399 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3400
3401 Examples :
3402 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3403 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3404 backend https_relay
3405 mode tcp
3406 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3407 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3408
3409 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003410 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3411 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003412
3413
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003414option httpclose
3415no option httpclose
3416 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3418 yes | yes | yes | yes
3419 Arguments : none
3420
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003421 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3422 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3423 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3424 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3425 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3426 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3427 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428
3429 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003430 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003431 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3432 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3433 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3434 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3435 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003436
3437 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3438 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3439 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003440 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3441 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003442
3443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3445
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003446 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3447 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003448
3449
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003450option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003451 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3453 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003454 Arguments :
3455 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3456 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3457 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3458 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3459 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003460
3461 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3462 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3463 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3464 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3465 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3466 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3467 ports.
3468
3469 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3470
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3473 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3474 by default.
3475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003476 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003477
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003478
3479option http_proxy
3480no option http_proxy
3481 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | yes | yes | yes
3484 Arguments : none
3485
3486 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3487 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3488 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3489 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3490 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3491
3492 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3493 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3494 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3495 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003496 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003497 be analyzed.
3498
3499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3501
3502 Example :
3503 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3504 backend direct_forward
3505 option httpclose
3506 option http_proxy
3507
3508 See also : "option httpclose"
3509
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003510
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003511option independent-streams
3512no option independent-streams
3513 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3515 yes | yes | yes | yes
3516 Arguments : none
3517
3518 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3519 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3520 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3521 receive data or not.
3522
3523 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3524 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3525 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3526 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3527 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3528 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3529 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3530 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3531 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3532 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3533 socket buffers.
3534
3535 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3536 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3537 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3538 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3539 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3540
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003541 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3542 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3543 deprecated.
3544
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003545 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003546
3547
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003548option ldap-check
3549 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3551 yes | no | yes | yes
3552 Arguments : none
3553
3554 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3555 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3556 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3557 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3558
3559 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3560 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3561
3562 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3563 configure it.
3564
3565 Example :
3566 option ldap-check
3567
3568 See also : "option httpchk"
3569
3570
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003571option log-health-checks
3572no option log-health-checks
3573 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | no | yes | yes
3576 Arguments : none
3577
3578 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3579 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3580 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3581 of additional information is limited.
3582
3583 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3584 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3585
3586 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3587
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003588
3589option log-separate-errors
3590no option log-separate-errors
3591 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | no
3594 Arguments : none
3595
3596 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3597 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3598 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3599 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3600 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3601 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3602 provides very important information.
3603
3604 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3605 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3606 error logs.
3607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003608 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003609 logging.
3610
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003611
3612option logasap
3613no option logasap
3614 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | no
3617 Arguments : none
3618
3619 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3620 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3621 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3622 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3623 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3624 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3625 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003626 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003627 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3628 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3629
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003630 Examples :
3631 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3632 mode http
3633 option httplog
3634 option logasap
3635 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3636
3637 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3638 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3639 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3640 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003642 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003643 logging.
3644
3645
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003646option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3647 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003650 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003651 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3652 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003653
3654 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3655 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3656 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3657 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3658 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3659 in the MySQL table, like this :
3660
3661 USE mysql;
3662 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3663 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3664
3665 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3666 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3667 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3668 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3669 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3670 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3671 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3672 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3673 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3674
3675 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3676 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003677
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003678 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003679
3680 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3681 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3682 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3683 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3684 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3685 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3686
3687 See also: "option httpchk"
3688
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003689option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3690 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 yes | no | yes | yes
3693 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003694 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3695 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003696
3697 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3698 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3699 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3700 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3701
3702 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003703
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003704option nolinger
3705no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003706 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3708 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003709 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003710
3711 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3712 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3713 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3714 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3715 connections.
3716
3717 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3718 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3719 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3720 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3721 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3722 this too.
3723
3724 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3725 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3726 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3727
3728 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3729 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3730 for servers.
3731
3732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3734
3735
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003736option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3737 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740 Arguments :
3741 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3742 matching <network>
3743 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3744 header name.
3745
3746 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3747 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3748 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3749 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3750 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3751 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3752 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3753 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3754 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3755 possible that the client has already brought one.
3756
3757 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3758 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3759 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3760 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3761 header and requires different one.
3762
3763 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3764 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3765 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3766 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3767 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3768 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3769 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3770
3771 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3772 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3773 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3774 both are defined.
3775
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003776 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3777 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3778 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3779 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3780 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003781
3782 Examples :
3783 # Original Destination address
3784 frontend www
3785 mode http
3786 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3787
3788 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3789 backend www
3790 mode http
3791 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3792
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003793 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3794 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003795
3796
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003797option persist
3798no option persist
3799 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003802 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003803
3804 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3805 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3806 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3807 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3808 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3809 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3810 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3811 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3812 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3813 redirected to another valid server.
3814
3815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3817
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003818 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003819
3820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003821option redispatch
3822no option redispatch
3823 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3825 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003826 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003827
3828 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3829 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3830 be able to access the service anymore.
3831
3832 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3833 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3834
3835 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3836 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3837 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003839 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3840 "redisp" keywords.
3841
3842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3844
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003845 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003846
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003847
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003848option redis-check
3849 Use redis health checks for server testing
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | no | yes | yes
3852 Arguments : none
3853
3854 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3855 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3856 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3857 find the "+PONG" response message.
3858
3859 Example :
3860 option redis-check
3861
3862 See also : "option httpchk"
3863
3864
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003865option smtpchk
3866option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3867 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003870 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003871 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3872 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3873 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3874
3875 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3876 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3877 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3878
3879 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3880 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3881 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3882 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3883 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3884 dead server.
3885
3886 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3887 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3888 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3889 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3890
3891 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3892 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3893 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3894 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3895 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3896
3897 Example :
3898 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3899
3900 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003903option socket-stats
3904no option socket-stats
3905
3906 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | no
3909
3910 Arguments : none
3911
3912
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003913option splice-auto
3914no option splice-auto
3915 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | yes | yes | yes
3918 Arguments : none
3919
3920 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3921 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3922 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3923 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003924 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003925 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3926 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3927 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3928 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3929
3930 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3931 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3932 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3933 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3934 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3935 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3936 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3937 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3938 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3939 keyword.
3940
3941 Example :
3942 option splice-auto
3943
3944 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3945 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3946
3947 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3948 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3949
3950
3951option splice-request
3952no option splice-request
3953 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3955 yes | yes | yes | yes
3956 Arguments : none
3957
3958 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003959 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003960 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3961 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3962 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3963 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3964
3965 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3966
3967 Example :
3968 option splice-request
3969
3970 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3971 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3972
3973 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3974 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3975
3976
3977option splice-response
3978no option splice-response
3979 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | yes | yes | yes
3982 Arguments : none
3983
3984 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003985 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003986 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3987 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3988 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3989 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3990
3991 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3992
3993 Example :
3994 option splice-response
3995
3996 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3997 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3998
3999 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4000 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4001
4002
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004003option srvtcpka
4004no option srvtcpka
4005 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 yes | no | yes | yes
4008 Arguments : none
4009
4010 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4011 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4012 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4013 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4014
4015 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4016 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4017 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4018 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4019
4020 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4021 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4022 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4023 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4024 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4025
4026 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4027
4028 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4029 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4030 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4031
4032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4034
4035 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4036
4037
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004038option ssl-hello-chk
4039 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 yes | no | yes | yes
4042 Arguments : none
4043
4044 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4045 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4046 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4047 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4048 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4049 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4050 hello message.
4051
4052 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4053 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4054 messages, which is appreciable.
4055
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004056 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4057 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4058 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004059
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004060 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4061
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004062
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004063option tcp-smart-accept
4064no option tcp-smart-accept
4065 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4067 yes | yes | yes | no
4068 Arguments : none
4069
4070 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4071 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4072 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4073 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4074 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4075 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4076
4077 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4078 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4079 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4080 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4081
4082 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4083 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4084 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4085 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4086
4087 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4088 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4089 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4090
4091 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4092 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4093 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4094
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004095 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4096
4097
4098option tcp-smart-connect
4099no option tcp-smart-connect
4100 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4102 yes | no | yes | yes
4103 Arguments : none
4104
4105 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4106 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4107 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4108 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4109 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4110
4111 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4112 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4113 complex.
4114
4115 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4116 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4117 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4118
4119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4121
4122 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4123
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004124
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004125option tcpka
4126 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 yes | yes | yes | yes
4129 Arguments : none
4130
4131 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4132 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4133 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4134 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4135
4136 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4137 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4138 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4139 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4140
4141 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4142 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4143 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4144 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4145 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4146
4147 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4148
4149 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4150 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4151 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4152 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4153 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4154 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4155 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4156 backends.
4157
4158 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4159
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004160
4161option tcplog
4162 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4164 yes | yes | yes | yes
4165 Arguments : none
4166
4167 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4168 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4169 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4170 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4171 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4172 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4173 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4174 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4175
4176 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004178 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004179
4180
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004181option transparent
4182no option transparent
4183 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004185 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004186 Arguments : none
4187
4188 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4189 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4190 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4191 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4192 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4193 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4194 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4195 appropriate server.
4196
4197 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4198 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4199
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004200 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004201 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004202
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004203
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004204persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004205persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004206 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 yes | no | yes | yes
4209 Arguments :
4210 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004211 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4212 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004213
4214 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4215 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4216 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4217 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4218 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4219 forwarded to this server.
4220
4221 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4222 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4223 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004224 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004225 a single "listen" section.
4226
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004227 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4228 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4229 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4230
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004231 Example :
4232 listen tse-farm
4233 bind :3389
4234 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4235 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4236 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4237 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4238 persist rdp-cookie
4239 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004240 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004241 balance rdp-cookie
4242 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4243 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4244
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004245 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4246 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004247
4248
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004249rate-limit sessions <rate>
4250 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | yes | yes | no
4253 Arguments :
4254 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4255 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4256
4257 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4258 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4259 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4260 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4261 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4262 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4263
4264 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4265 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4266 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4267 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4268
4269 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4270 listen smtp
4271 mode tcp
4272 bind :25
4273 rate-limit sessions 10
4274 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4275
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004276 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4277 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4278 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004279
4280 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4281
4282
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004283redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4284redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4285redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004286 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4288 no | yes | yes | yes
4289
4290 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004291 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004292
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004294 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4295 the HTTP "Location" header.
4296
4297 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4298 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4299 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4300 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4301 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4302 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4303
4304 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4305 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4306 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4307 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4308 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4309 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4310 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4311 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4312 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004313
4314 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4315 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4316 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4317 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4318 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4319 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4320 location with a GET method.
4321
4322 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4323 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4324
4325 - "drop-query"
4326 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4327 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4328 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4329 with a location-type redirect.
4330
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004331 - "append-slash"
4332 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4333 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4334 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4335 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4336
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004337 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4338 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4339 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4340 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4341 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4342 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4343 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4344
4345 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4346 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4347 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4348 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4349 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4350 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4351 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004352
4353 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4354 acl clear dst_port 80
4355 acl secure dst_port 8080
4356 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004357 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004358 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004359 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4360
4361 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004362 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4363 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4364 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004365 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004366
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004367 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4368 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4369 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4370
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004371 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004372 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004374 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004375
4376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004377redisp (deprecated)
4378redispatch (deprecated)
4379 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004382 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004383
4384 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4385 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4386 be able to access the service anymore.
4387
4388 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4389 redistribute them to a working server.
4390
4391 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4392 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4393 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004395 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4396 "option redispatch" instead.
4397
4398 See also : "option redispatch"
4399
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004400
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004401reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004402 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 no | yes | yes | yes
4405 Arguments :
4406 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4407 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004408 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004409
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004410 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4411 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004413 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4414 the last header of an HTTP request.
4415
4416 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4417 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4418 responses.
4419
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004420 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4421 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4422 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4423
4424 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4425 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004426
4427
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004428reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4429reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004430 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4432 no | yes | yes | yes
4433 Arguments :
4434 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4435 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4436 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4437 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4438 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4439 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4440 ignores case.
4441
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004442 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4443 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4444
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004445 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4446 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4447 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4448 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004449 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004450
4451 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4452 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4453
4454 Example :
4455 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4456 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4457 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4458
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004459 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4460 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004461
4462
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004463reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4464reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004465 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 no | yes | yes | yes
4468 Arguments :
4469 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4470 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4471 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4472 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4473 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4474 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4475
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004476 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4477 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4478
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004479 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4480 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4481 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4482 next servers.
4483
4484 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4485 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4486 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4487
4488 Example :
4489 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4490 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4491 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4492
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004493 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4494 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004495
4496
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004497reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4498reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004499 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4501 no | yes | yes | yes
4502 Arguments :
4503 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4504 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4505 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4506 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4507 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4508 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4509 case.
4510
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004511 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4512 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4513
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004514 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4515 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4516 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4517 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004518 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004519
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004520 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004521 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004522 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004523
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004524 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4525 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4526
4527 Example :
4528 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4529 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4530 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4531
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004532 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4533 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004534
4535
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004536reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4537reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004538 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4540 no | yes | yes | yes
4541 Arguments :
4542 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4543 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4544 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4545 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4546 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4547 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4548 case.
4549
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004550 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4551 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4552
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004553 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4554 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4555 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4556 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4557
4558 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4559 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4560
4561 Example :
4562 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4563 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4564 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4565 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4566
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004567 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4568 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569
4570
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004571reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4572reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004573 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 no | yes | yes | yes
4576 Arguments :
4577 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4578 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4579 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4580 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4581 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4582 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4583
4584 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4585 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4586 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4587 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004588 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004589
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004590 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4591 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4592
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004593 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4594 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4595 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4596
4597 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4598 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4599 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4600 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4601 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4602
4603 Example :
4604 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004605 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004606 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4607 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4608
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004609 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4610 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004611
4612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004613reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4614reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004615 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4617 no | yes | yes | yes
4618 Arguments :
4619 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4620 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4621 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4622 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4623 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4624 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4625 ignores case.
4626
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004627 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4628 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4629
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004630 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4631 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004632 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4633 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4634 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004635 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4636 not set.
4637
4638 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4639 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4640 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4641 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4642 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4643
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004644 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004645 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4646 # block all others.
4647 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4648 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4649
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004650 # block bad guys
4651 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4652 reqitarpit . if badguys
4653
4654 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4655 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004656
4657
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004658retries <value>
4659 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | no | yes | yes
4662 Arguments :
4663 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4664 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4665 default value is 3.
4666
4667 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4668 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4669 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4670
4671 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4672 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4673
4674 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4675 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4676
4677 See also : "option redispatch"
4678
4679
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004680rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004681 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 no | yes | yes | yes
4684 Arguments :
4685 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4686 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004687 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004688
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004689 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4690 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4691
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004692 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4693 the last header of an HTTP response.
4694
4695 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4696 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4697 responses.
4698
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004699 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4700 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004701
4702
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004703rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4704rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004705 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 no | yes | yes | yes
4708 Arguments :
4709 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4710 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4711 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4712 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4713 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4714 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4715 ignores case.
4716
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4721 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004722 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004723 client.
4724
4725 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4726 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4727 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4728
4729 Example :
4730 # remove the Server header from responses
4731 reqidel ^Server:.*
4732
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004733 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4734 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004735
4736
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004737rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4738rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004739 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 no | yes | yes | yes
4742 Arguments :
4743 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4744 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4745 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4746 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4747 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4748 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4749 ignores case.
4750
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004751 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4752 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4753
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004754 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4755 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4756 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4757 case-sensitive.
4758
4759 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004760 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4761 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4762 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004763
4764 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4765 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4766
4767 Example :
4768 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4769 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4770
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004771 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4772 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004773
4774
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004775rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4776rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004777 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 no | yes | yes | yes
4780 Arguments :
4781 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4782 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4783 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4784 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4785 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4786 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4787 ignores case.
4788
4789 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4790 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4791 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4792 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004793 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004794
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004795 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4796 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4797
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004798 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4799 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4800 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4801
4802 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4803 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4804 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4805 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4806 are not case-sensitive.
4807
4808 Example :
4809 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4810 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4811
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004812 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4813 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004814
4815
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004816server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004817 Declare a server in a backend
4818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4819 no | no | yes | yes
4820 Arguments :
4821 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004822 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004823 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004824
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004825 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4826 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4827 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4828 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004829 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4830 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4831 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4832 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4833 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4834 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004835
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004836 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004837 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4838 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4839 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4840 adding this value to the client's port.
4841
4842 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4843 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004844 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004845
4846 Examples :
4847 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4848 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4849
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004850 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4851 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004852
4853
4854source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004855source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004856source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004857 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | no | yes | yes
4860 Arguments :
4861 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4862 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4863 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4864 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4865
4866 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4867 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004868 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4869 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4870 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004871
4872 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4873 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4874 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4875 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4876 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4877 <addr>.
4878
4879 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4880 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4881 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4882 port.
4883
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004884 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4885 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4886 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4887 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4888 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4889 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4890 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4891 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4892 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4893 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4894 HTTP header.
4895
4896 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4897 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004898 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004899 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4900 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4901 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4902 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4903 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4904 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4905 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4906
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004907 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4908 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4909 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4910 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4911 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4912 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4913
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004914 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4915 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4916 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4917 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4918
4919 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4920 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4921 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4922 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4923 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4924 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4925
4926 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4927 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4928 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4929 there are two methods :
4930
4931 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4932 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4933 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4934 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4935 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4936 of the client ranges may be used.
4937
4938 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4939 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4940 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4941 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4942 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4943 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4944 same session.
4945
4946 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4947 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4948 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4949 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4950 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4951 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4952
4953 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4954 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4955 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004956 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004957
4958 Examples :
4959 backend private
4960 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4961 source 192.168.1.200
4962
4963 backend transparent_ssl1
4964 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4965 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4966
4967 backend transparent_ssl2
4968 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4969 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4970 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4971
4972 backend transparent_ssl3
4973 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4974 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4975 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4976
4977 backend transparent_smtp
4978 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4979 # with Tproxy version 4.
4980 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4981
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004982 backend transparent_http
4983 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4984 # proxy.
4985 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004987 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004988 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004990
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004991srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4992 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | no | yes | yes
4995 Arguments :
4996 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4997 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4998 as explained at the top of this document.
4999
5000 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5001 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5002 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5003 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5004 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5005 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5006 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5007
5008 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5009 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5010 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5011 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5012 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005013 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005014 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005015 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005016
5017 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5018 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5019 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5020 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5021 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5022 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5023
5024 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5025 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5026
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005027 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5028 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005029
5030
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005031stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5032 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5034 no | no | yes | yes
5035
5036 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5037 matched.
5038
5039 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5040 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5041
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005042 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5043 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5044 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5045
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005046 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5047 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5048 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5049 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005050
5051 Example :
5052 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5053 backend stats_localhost
5054 stats enable
5055 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5056
5057 Example :
5058 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5059 backend stats_auth
5060 stats enable
5061 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5062 stats admin if TRUE
5063
5064 Example :
5065 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5066 userlist stats-auth
5067 group admin users admin
5068 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5069 group readonly users haproxy
5070 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5071
5072 backend stats_auth
5073 stats enable
5074 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5075 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5076 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5077 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5078
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005079 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5080 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5081 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005082
5083
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005084stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5085 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5087 yes | no | yes | yes
5088 Arguments :
5089 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5090
5091 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5092
5093 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5094 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5095 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5096 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5097 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5098 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5099
5100 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5101 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5102 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005103 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005104
5105 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5106 report using "stats scope".
5107
5108 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5109 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5110 unobvious parameters.
5111
5112 Example :
5113 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5114 backend public_www
5115 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5116 stats enable
5117 stats hide-version
5118 stats scope .
5119 stats uri /admin?stats
5120 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5121 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5122 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5123
5124 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5125 backend private_monitoring
5126 stats enable
5127 stats uri /admin?stats
5128 stats refresh 5s
5129
5130 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5131
5132
5133stats enable
5134 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | no | yes | yes
5137 Arguments : none
5138
5139 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5140 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5141 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5142 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5143 - stats auth : no authentication
5144 - stats scope : no restriction
5145
5146 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5147 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5148 unobvious parameters.
5149
5150 Example :
5151 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5152 backend public_www
5153 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5154 stats enable
5155 stats hide-version
5156 stats scope .
5157 stats uri /admin?stats
5158 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5159 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5160 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5161
5162 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5163 backend private_monitoring
5164 stats enable
5165 stats uri /admin?stats
5166 stats refresh 5s
5167
5168 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5169
5170
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005171stats hide-version
5172 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005175 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005176
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005177 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5178 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5179 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5180 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5181 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5182 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005184 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5185 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5186 unobvious parameters.
5187
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005188 Example :
5189 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5190 backend public_www
5191 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005192 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005193 stats hide-version
5194 stats scope .
5195 stats uri /admin?stats
5196 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5197 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5198 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005199
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005200 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5201 backend private_monitoring
5202 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005203 stats uri /admin?stats
5204 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005205
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005206 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005207
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005208
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005209stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5210 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5211 Access control for statistics
5212
5213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5214 no | no | yes | yes
5215
5216 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5217 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5218 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5219 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5220 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5221 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5222
5223 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5224 instance.
5225
5226 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5227 about ACL usage.
5228
5229
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005230stats realm <realm>
5231 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5233 yes | no | yes | yes
5234 Arguments :
5235 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5236 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5237 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5238
5239 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5240 using a backslash ('\').
5241
5242 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5243 only related to authentication.
5244
5245 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5246 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5247 unobvious parameters.
5248
5249 Example :
5250 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5251 backend public_www
5252 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5253 stats enable
5254 stats hide-version
5255 stats scope .
5256 stats uri /admin?stats
5257 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5258 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5259 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5260
5261 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5262 backend private_monitoring
5263 stats enable
5264 stats uri /admin?stats
5265 stats refresh 5s
5266
5267 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5268
5269
5270stats refresh <delay>
5271 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 yes | no | yes | yes
5274 Arguments :
5275 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5276 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5277 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5278 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5279 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5280 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5281
5282 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5283 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5284 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5285 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5286
5287 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5288 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5289 unobvious parameters.
5290
5291 Example :
5292 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5293 backend public_www
5294 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5295 stats enable
5296 stats hide-version
5297 stats scope .
5298 stats uri /admin?stats
5299 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5300 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5301 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5302
5303 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5304 backend private_monitoring
5305 stats enable
5306 stats uri /admin?stats
5307 stats refresh 5s
5308
5309 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5310
5311
5312stats scope { <name> | "." }
5313 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5315 yes | no | yes | yes
5316 Arguments :
5317 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5318 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5319 section in which the statement appears.
5320
5321 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5322 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5323 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5324 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5325 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5326 exists.
5327
5328 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5329 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5330 unobvious parameters.
5331
5332 Example :
5333 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5334 backend public_www
5335 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5336 stats enable
5337 stats hide-version
5338 stats scope .
5339 stats uri /admin?stats
5340 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5341 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5342 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5343
5344 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5345 backend private_monitoring
5346 stats enable
5347 stats uri /admin?stats
5348 stats refresh 5s
5349
5350 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5351
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005352
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005353stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005354 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | no | yes | yes
5357
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005358 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005359 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5360
5361 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5362 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5363
5364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005366 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005367
5368 Example :
5369 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5370 backend private_monitoring
5371 stats enable
5372 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5373 stats uri /admin?stats
5374 stats refresh 5s
5375
5376 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5377 global section.
5378
5379
5380stats show-legends
5381 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5382 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5383 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5384 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5385 - IP (socket, server)
5386 - cookie (backend, server)
5387
5388 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5389 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005390 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005391
5392 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5393
5394
5395stats show-node [ <name> ]
5396 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5398 yes | no | yes | yes
5399 Arguments:
5400 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5401 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5402
5403 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5404 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005405 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005406
5407 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5408 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5409 unobvious parameters.
5410
5411 Example:
5412 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5413 backend private_monitoring
5414 stats enable
5415 stats show-node Europe-1
5416 stats uri /admin?stats
5417 stats refresh 5s
5418
5419 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5420 section.
5421
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005422
5423stats uri <prefix>
5424 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | no | yes | yes
5427 Arguments :
5428 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5429 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5430 query string.
5431
5432 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5433 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5434 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5435 possible to reach it in the application.
5436
5437 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005438 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005439 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5440 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5441 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5442 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5443
5444 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5445 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5446 an address or a port to statistics only.
5447
5448 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5449 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5450 unobvious parameters.
5451
5452 Example :
5453 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5454 backend public_www
5455 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5456 stats enable
5457 stats hide-version
5458 stats scope .
5459 stats uri /admin?stats
5460 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5461 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5462 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5463
5464 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5465 backend private_monitoring
5466 stats enable
5467 stats uri /admin?stats
5468 stats refresh 5s
5469
5470 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5471
5472
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005473stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5474 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005476 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005477
5478 Arguments :
5479 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5480 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5481 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5482 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5483
5484 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5485 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5486 the "stick-table" statement.
5487
5488 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5489 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5490 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5491 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5492 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5493
5494 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5495 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5496 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5497 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5498 transformation rules.
5499
5500 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5501 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5502 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5503 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5504 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5505 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5506 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5507
5508 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5509 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5510 ACL based conditions.
5511
5512 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5513 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5514 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5515 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5516
5517 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5518 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5519 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5520 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5521
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005522 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5523 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5524 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5525
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005526 Example :
5527 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5528 # last 30 minutes
5529 backend pop
5530 mode tcp
5531 balance roundrobin
5532 stick store-request src
5533 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5534 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5535 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5536
5537 backend smtp
5538 mode tcp
5539 balance roundrobin
5540 stick match src table pop
5541 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5542 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5543
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005544 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5545 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005546
5547
5548stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5549 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 no | no | yes | yes
5552
5553 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5554 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5555 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5556 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5557
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005558 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5559 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5560 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5561
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005562 Examples :
5563 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005564 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005565
5566 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5567 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5568 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5569
5570
5571 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5572 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5573 backend http
5574 mode http
5575 balance roundrobin
5576 stick on src table https
5577 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5578 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5579 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5580
5581 backend https
5582 mode tcp
5583 balance roundrobin
5584 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5585 stick on src
5586 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5587 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5588
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005589 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005590
5591
5592stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5593 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 no | no | yes | yes
5596
5597 Arguments :
5598 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5599 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5600 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5601 server is selected.
5602
5603 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5604 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5605 the "stick-table" statement.
5606
5607 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5608 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5609 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5610 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5611 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5612 address.
5613
5614 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5615 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5616 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5617 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5618 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5619 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5620 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5621 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5622 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5623 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5624
5625 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5626 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5627 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5628 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5629 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5630 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5631 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5632
5633 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5634 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5635 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5636 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5637
5638 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5639 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5640 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5641 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5642 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5643 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5644 another protocol or access method.
5645
5646 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5647 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5648 the request.
5649
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005650 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5651 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5652 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5653
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005654 Example :
5655 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5656 # last 30 minutes
5657 backend pop
5658 mode tcp
5659 balance roundrobin
5660 stick store-request src
5661 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5662 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5663 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5664
5665 backend smtp
5666 mode tcp
5667 balance roundrobin
5668 stick match src table pop
5669 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5670 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5671
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005672 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5673 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005674
5675
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005676stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005677 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5678 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005679 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005681 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005682
5683 Arguments :
5684 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5685 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5686 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5687 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5688
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005689 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5690 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5691 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5692 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5693
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005694 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5695 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5696 instance.
5697
5698 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5699 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5700 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5701 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5702 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5703 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005704 to 32 characters.
5705
5706 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5707 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5708 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5709 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5710 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5711 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005712
5713 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005714 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5715 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005716 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5717 increase.
5718
5719 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005720 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5721 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5722 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005723
5724 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5725 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5726 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5727 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5728 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5729 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5730 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5731 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5732 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5733 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5734 parameter (see below).
5735
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005736 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5737 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5738 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5739 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5740 soft restart.
5741
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005742 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5743
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005744 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5745 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5746 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5747 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5748 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005749 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005750 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5751 if not expiration delay is specified.
5752
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005753 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5754 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5755 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5756 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005757 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5758 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5759 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5760 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5761 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5762 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5763 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5764 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5765 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5766 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5767 types and their arguments.
5768
5769 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5770 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5771 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5772 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5773
5774 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5775 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5776 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5777 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5778
5779 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5780 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5781 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5782 they were received.
5783
5784 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5785 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5786 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5787 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5788 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5789
5790 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5791 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5792 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5793 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5794 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5795
5796 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5797 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5798 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5799
5800 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5801 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5802 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5803 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5804 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5805
5806 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5807 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5808 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5809 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5810 the client side.
5811
5812 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5813 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5814 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5815 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5816 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5817 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5818 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5819
5820 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5821 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5822 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5823 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5824 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5825 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5826 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5827
5828 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5829 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5830 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5831 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5832 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5833 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5834
5835 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5836 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5837 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5838 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5839
5840 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5841 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5842 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5843 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5844 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5845 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5846 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5847 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5848 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5849 recommended for better fairness.
5850
5851 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5852 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5853 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5854 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5855
5856 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5857 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5859 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5860 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5861 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5862 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5863 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5864 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5865 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005866
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005867 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5868 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005869 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5870 reference it.
5871
5872 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5873 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5874 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5875 as an exclusive stickiness.
5876
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005877 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5878 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5879 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5880 something that can be ignored.
5881
5882 Example:
5883 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5884 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5885 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5886 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5887
5888 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005889 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005890
5891
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005892stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5893 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 no | no | yes | yes
5896
5897 Arguments :
5898 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5899 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5900 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5901 server is selected.
5902
5903 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5904 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5905 the "stick-table" statement.
5906
5907 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5908 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5909 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5910 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5911
5912 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5913 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5914 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5915 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5916 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5917 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005918 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005919 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5920 rules.
5921
5922 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5923 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5924 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5925 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5926 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5927 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5928 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5929
5930 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5931 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5932 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5933 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5934
5935 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5936 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5937 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5938 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5939 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5940 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5941 another protocol or access method.
5942
5943 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5944
5945 Example :
5946 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5947 backend https
5948 mode tcp
5949 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005950 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005951 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005952
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005953 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5954 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5955
5956 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5957 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5958 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5959
5960 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5961 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005962
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005963 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5964 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5965 # at offset 44.
5966
5967 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5968 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5969
5970 # Learn on response if server hello.
5971 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005972
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005973 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5974 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5975
5976 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5977 extraction.
5978
5979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005980tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5981 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005984 Arguments :
5985 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5986 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5987 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005988
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005989 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005990
5991 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5992 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5994 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5995 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5996 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5997 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5998 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005999
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006000 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6001 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6002 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6003 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 Three types of actions are supported :
6006 - accept :
6007 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6008 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6009 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006010
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006011 - reject :
6012 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6013 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6014 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6015 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6016 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6017 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6018 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6019 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6020 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6021 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6022 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6023 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006025 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6026 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6027 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6028 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6029 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6030 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6031 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6032 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6033 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006035 These actions take one or two arguments :
6036 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6037 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6038 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6041 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6042 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6043 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006045 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6046 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6047 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6048 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6049 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6050 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6051 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6052 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6053 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6054 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6057 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6058 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6061 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6062 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006064 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006065 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006066 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006068 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6069 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6070 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6073 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6074 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006075
6076 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006079
6080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006081tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6082 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006084 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006085 Arguments :
6086 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6087 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6088 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006090 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006092 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6093 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6094 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6095 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6096 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006098 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6099 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6100 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6101 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6102 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6103 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6104 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6105 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6106 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006108 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6109 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6110 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6111 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 Three types of actions are supported :
6114 - accept :
6115 - reject :
6116 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6119 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006121 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6122 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6123 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6124 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6125 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6126 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006128 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006129 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6130 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006132 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006133 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6134 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6135 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6136 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6137 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006138
6139 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006140 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6141 # and reject everything else.
6142 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6143 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006144 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006145 tcp-request content reject
6146
6147 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006148 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6149 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6150 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006151 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006152
6153 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6154 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6155 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006156 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006157 tcp-request content reject
6158
6159 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6160 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6161
6162 frontend http
6163 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6164 # protecting all our sites
6165 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6166 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6167 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6168 ...
6169 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6170
6171 backend http_dynamic
6172 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6173 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6174 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6175 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6176 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6177 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6178 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006180 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006182 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006183
6184
6185tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6186 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006188 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006189 Arguments :
6190 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6191 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6192 as explained at the top of this document.
6193
6194 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6195 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6196 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6197 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6198 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6199
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006200 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6201 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6202 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6203 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6204
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006205 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6206 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006207 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006208 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006209 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6210 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6211 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6212 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006213
6214 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6215 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6216 it pass through unaffected.
6217
6218 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6219 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6220 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006221 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006222 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6223 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006224 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6225 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6226 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006227
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006228 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006229 "timeout client".
6230
6231
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006232tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6233 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 no | no | yes | yes
6236 Arguments :
6237 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6238 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6239 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6240
6241 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6242
6243 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6244 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6245 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6246 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006247 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006248
6249 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6250
6251 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6252 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6253 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6254 inserted.
6255
6256 Two types of actions are supported :
6257 - accept :
6258 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6259 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6260 the rules evaluation.
6261
6262 - reject :
6263 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6264 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006265 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006266
6267 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6268 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6269 for changing the default action to a reject.
6270
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006271 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6272 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6273 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6274 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006275 period.
6276
6277 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6278
6279 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6280
6281
6282tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6283 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6285 no | no | yes | yes
6286 Arguments :
6287 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6288 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6289 as explained at the top of this document.
6290
6291 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6292
6293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006294timeout check <timeout>
6295 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6296 established.
6297
6298 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6299 yes | no | yes | yes
6300 Arguments:
6301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6303 as explained at the top of this document.
6304
6305 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6306 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6307 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6308 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006309 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6310 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6311 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006312
6313 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6314 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6315
6316 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6317 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006318 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006319
6320 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6321 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6322 forget about it.
6323
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006324 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6325 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006326
6327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006328timeout client <timeout>
6329timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6330 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6332 yes | yes | yes | no
6333 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6336 as explained at the top of this document.
6337
6338 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6339 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6340 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6341 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6342 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6343 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6344 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6345 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006346 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006347 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006348 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6349 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6350 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006351
6352 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6353 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6354 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6355 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6356 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6357 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6358
6359 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6360 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6361 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6362
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006363 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006364
6365
6366timeout connect <timeout>
6367timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6368 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6370 yes | no | yes | yes
6371 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006372 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6374 as explained at the top of this document.
6375
6376 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006377 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006378 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006379 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006380 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6381 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006382
6383 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6384 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6385 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6386 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6387 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6388 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6389
6390 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6391 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6392 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6393
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006394 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6395 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006396
6397
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006398timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6399 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6401 yes | yes | yes | yes
6402 Arguments :
6403 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6405 as explained at the top of this document.
6406
6407 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6408 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6409 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6410 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6411 once the request has started to present itself.
6412
6413 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6414 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6415 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6416 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6417 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6418
6419 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6420 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6421 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6422 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6423
6424 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6425 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6426 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6427 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6428 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006429 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006430
6431 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6432 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6433 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6434 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6435
6436 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6437
6438
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006439timeout http-request <timeout>
6440 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006442 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006444 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006445 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6446 as explained at the top of this document.
6447
6448 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6449 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6450 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6451 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6452 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6453 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6454 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6455 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6456
6457 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6458 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006459 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6460 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006461
6462 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6463 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6464 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6465 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6466 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6467
6468 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006469 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6470 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6471 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006472
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006473 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006474
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006475
6476timeout queue <timeout>
6477 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6479 yes | no | yes | yes
6480 Arguments :
6481 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6482 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6483 as explained at the top of this document.
6484
6485 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6486 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6487 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6488 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6489 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6490
6491 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6492 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6493 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6494 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6495
6496 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6497
6498
6499timeout server <timeout>
6500timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6501 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6503 yes | no | yes | yes
6504 Arguments :
6505 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6506 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6507 as explained at the top of this document.
6508
6509 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6510 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6511 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6512 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6513 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6514 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6515 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6516
6517 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6518 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6519 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6520 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6521 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006522 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006523 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006524 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6525 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6526 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6527 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006528
6529 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6530 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6531 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6532 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6533 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6534 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6535
6536 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6537 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6538 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6539
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006540 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006541
6542
6543timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006544 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | yes | yes | yes
6547 Arguments :
6548 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6550 as explained at the top of this document.
6551
6552 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6553 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6554 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6555
6556 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6557 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6558 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6559 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006560 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006561
6562 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6563
6564
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006565timeout tunnel <timeout>
6566 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6568 yes | no | yes | yes
6569 Arguments :
6570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6572 as explained at the top of this document.
6573
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006574 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006575 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6576 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6577 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6578 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6579 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6580 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6581 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6582 specified.
6583
6584 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6585 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6586 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6587 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6588 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6589
6590 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6591 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6592 forget about it.
6593
6594 Example :
6595 defaults http
6596 option http-server-close
6597 timeout connect 5s
6598 timeout client 30s
6599 timeout client 30s
6600 timeout server 30s
6601 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6602
6603 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6604
6605
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006606transparent (deprecated)
6607 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006609 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6613 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6614 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6615 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6616 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6617 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6618 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6619 appropriate server.
6620
6621 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6622
6623 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6624 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6625
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006626 See also: "option transparent"
6627
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006628unique-id-format <string>
6629 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | yes | yes | no
6632 Arguments :
6633 <string> is a log-format string.
6634
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006635 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6636 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6637 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6638 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006640 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6641 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6642 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6643 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6644 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6645 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6646 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6647 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006648
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006649 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6650 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006651
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006652 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006653
6654 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6655
6656 will generate:
6657
6658 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6659
6660 See also: "unique-id-header"
6661
6662unique-id-header <name>
6663 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | no
6666 Arguments :
6667 <name> is the name of the header.
6668
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006669 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6670 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006671
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006672 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006673
6674 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6675 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6676
6677 will generate:
6678
6679 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6680
6681 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006682
6683use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6684use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006685 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 no | yes | yes | no
6688 Arguments :
6689 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006691 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006692
6693 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6694 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6695 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006696 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6697 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6698 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6699 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006700
6701 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6702 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6703 assign the backend.
6704
6705 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6706 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6707 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6708 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6709 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6710 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6711
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006712 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006713 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006714 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6715 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6716 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6717
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006718 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006719
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006720
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006721use-server <server> if <condition>
6722use-server <server> unless <condition>
6723 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 no | no | yes | yes
6726 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006727 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006728
6729 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6730
6731 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6732 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6733 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6734
6735 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6736 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6737 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6738 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6739 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6740 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6741 matches will assign the server.
6742
6743 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6744 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6745 with the next rules until one matches.
6746
6747 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6748 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6749 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6750 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6751
6752 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6753 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6754 stripped.
6755
6756 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6757 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6758 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6759 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6760
6761 Example :
6762 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6763 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6764 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6765 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6766 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6767 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6768 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6769 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6770 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6771
6772 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6773
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006774
67755. Bind and Server options
6776--------------------------
6777
6778The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6779depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6780settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6781written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6782described in this section.
6783
6784
67855.1. Bind options
6786-----------------
6787
6788The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6789as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6790no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6791parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6792while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6793provided immediately after the setting name.
6794
6795The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6796
6797accept-proxy
6798 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6799 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6800 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6801 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6802 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6803 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6804 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6805 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6806 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6807 usable.
6808
6809backlog <backlog>
6810 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6811 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6812
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006813ecdhe <named curve>
6814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6815 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6816 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6817
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006818ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6820 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6821 client's certificate.
6822
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006823ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6825 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6826 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6827 error is ignored.
6828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006829ciphers <ciphers>
6830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6831 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6832 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6833 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6834 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6835
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006836crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6838 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6839 to verify client's certificate.
6840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006841crt <cert>
6842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6843 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6844 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006845 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6846 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6847 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6848 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6849 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6850 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6851 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6852 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006853 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006854 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6855 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6856 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6857 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6858 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006859
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006860crt-ignore-err <errors>
6861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6862 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6863 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6864 error is ignored.
6865
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006866defer-accept
6867 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6868 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6869 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6870 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6871 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6872 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6873 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6874 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6875 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6876 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6877 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6878
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006879force-sslv3
6880 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6881 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6882 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6883
6884force-tlsv10
6885 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6886 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6887
6888force-tlsv11
6889 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6890 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6891
6892force-tlsv12
6893 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6894 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006896gid <gid>
6897 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6898 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6899 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6900 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6901 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6902
6903group <group>
6904 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6905 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6906 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6907 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6908 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6909
6910id <id>
6911 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6912 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6913 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6914 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6915
6916interface <interface>
6917 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6918 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6919 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6920 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6921 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6922 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6923 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6924 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6925
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006926level <level>
6927 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6928 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6929 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6930 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6931 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6932 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6933 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6934 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6935 counters).
6936 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6937 all counters).
6938
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006939maxconn <maxconn>
6940 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6941 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6942 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6943 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6944 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6945 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6946 eat all memory.
6947
6948mode <mode>
6949 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6950 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6951 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6952 UNIX sockets.
6953
6954mss <maxseg>
6955 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6956 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6957 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6958 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6959 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6960 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6961 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6962 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6963 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6964 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6965 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6966
6967name <name>
6968 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6969 page.
6970
6971nice <nice>
6972 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6973 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6974 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6975 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6976 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6977 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6978 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6979 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6980 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6981 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6982 one for an RDP socket.
6983
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006984no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6986 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6987 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006988 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6989 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006990
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02006991no-tls-tickets
6992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6993 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
6994 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
6995 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
6996
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006997no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006999 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7000 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7001 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7002 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007003
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007004no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007006 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7007 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7008 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7009 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007010
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007011no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007013 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7014 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7015 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7016 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007017
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007018npn <protocols>
7019 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7020 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7021 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7022 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7023 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7024
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007025ssl
7026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7027 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7028 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7029 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7030 to deciphered contents.
7031
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007032tfo
7033 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7034 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7035 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7036 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7037 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7038 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7039 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7040 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7041 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7042
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007043transparent
7044 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7045 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7046 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7047 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7048 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7049 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7050 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7051 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7052 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7053 so check for support with your vendor.
7054
7055uid <uid>
7056 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7057 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7058 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7059 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7060 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7061
7062user <user>
7063 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7064 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7065 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7066 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7067 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7068
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007069verify [none|optional|required]
7070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7071 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7072 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7073 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7074 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007075 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7076 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7077 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7078 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020070805.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007081------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007082
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007083The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7084which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7085arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7086settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7087after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7088Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7089address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007091 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007092 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007094The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007095
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007096addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007097 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7098 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7099 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7100 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7101 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007103 Supported in default-server: No
7104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007105backup
7106 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7107 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7108 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7109 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7110 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7111 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007113 Supported in default-server: No
7114
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007115ca-file <cafile>
7116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7117 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7118 server's certificate.
7119
7120 Supported in default-server: No
7121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007122check
7123 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007124 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7125 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7126 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7127 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7128 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7129 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7130 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7131 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7132 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7133 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007135 Supported in default-server: No
7136
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007137check-send-proxy
7138 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7139 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7140 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7141 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7142 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7143 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7144 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7145
7146 Supported in default-server: No
7147
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007148check-ssl
7149 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7150 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7151 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7152 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7153 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7154 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7155 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7156 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7157 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7158
7159 Supported in default-server: No
7160
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007161ciphers <ciphers>
7162 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7163 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7164 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7165 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7166 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7167 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7168 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7169 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7170
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007171 Supported in default-server: No
7172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007173cookie <value>
7174 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7175 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7176 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7177 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7178 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7179 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7180 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007182 Supported in default-server: No
7183
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007184crl-file <crlfile>
7185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7186 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7187 to verify server's certificate.
7188
7189 Supported in default-server: No
7190
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007191crt <cert>
7192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7193 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7194 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7195 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7196 certificate request.
7197
7198 Supported in default-server: No
7199
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007200disabled
7201 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7202 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7203 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7204 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7205 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7206
7207 Supported in default-server: No
7208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007209error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007210 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7211 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7212 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007213
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007214 Supported in default-server: Yes
7215
7216 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007218fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007219 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7220 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7221 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007223 Supported in default-server: Yes
7224
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007225force-sslv3
7226 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7227 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7228 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7229
7230 Supported in default-server: No
7231
7232force-tlsv10
7233 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7234 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7235
7236 Supported in default-server: No
7237
7238force-tlsv11
7239 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7240 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7241
7242 Supported in default-server: No
7243
7244force-tlsv12
7245 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7246 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7247
7248 Supported in default-server: No
7249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007250id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007251 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7252 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7253 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007255 Supported in default-server: No
7256
7257inter <delay>
7258fastinter <delay>
7259downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007260 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7261 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7262 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7263 between checks depending on the server state :
7264
7265 Server state | Interval used
7266 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7267 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7268 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7269 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7270 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7271 or yet unchecked. |
7272 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7273 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7274 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007276 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7277 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7278 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7279 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7280 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7281 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7282 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7283 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7284 servers.
7285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007286 Supported in default-server: Yes
7287
7288maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007289 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7290 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7291 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7292 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7293 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7294 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7295 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7296 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007298 Supported in default-server: Yes
7299
7300maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007301 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7302 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7303 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7304 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7305 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7306 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7307 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007309 Supported in default-server: Yes
7310
7311minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007312 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7313 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7314 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7315 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7316 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7317 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007318 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007319 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007321 Supported in default-server: Yes
7322
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007323no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007324 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7325 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007326 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007327
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007328 Supported in default-server: No
7329
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007330no-tls-tickets
7331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7332 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7333 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7334 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7335
7336 Supported in default-server: No
7337
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007338no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007339 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007340 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7341 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007342 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7343 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007344
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007345 Supported in default-server: No
7346
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007347no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007348 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007349 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7350 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007351 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7352 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007353
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007354 Supported in default-server: No
7355
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007356no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007357 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007358 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7359 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007360 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7361 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007362
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007363 Supported in default-server: No
7364
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007365non-stick
7366 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7367 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7368 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7369
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007370 Supported in default-server: No
7371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007372observe <mode>
7373 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7374 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7375 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7376 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7377 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7378 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007379 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007381 Supported in default-server: No
7382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007383 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007385on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007386 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7387 Currently, four modes are available:
7388 - fastinter: force fastinter
7389 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7390 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7391 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7392 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007394 Supported in default-server: Yes
7395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007396 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7397
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007398on-marked-down <action>
7399 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7400 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007401 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7402 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7403 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7404 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7405 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7406 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7407 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7408 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007409
7410 Actions are disabled by default
7411
7412 Supported in default-server: Yes
7413
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007414on-marked-up <action>
7415 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7416 Currently one action is available:
7417 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7418 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7419 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7420 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7421 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7422 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7423 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7424 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7425
7426 Actions are disabled by default
7427
7428 Supported in default-server: Yes
7429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007430port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007431 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7432 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7433 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7434 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7435 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7436 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007438 Supported in default-server: Yes
7439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007440redir <prefix>
7441 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7442 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7443 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7444 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7445 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7446 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7447 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7448 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007449 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007450 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7451 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7452 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7453 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7454 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7455
7456 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007458 Supported in default-server: No
7459
7460rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007461 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7462 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7463 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007465 Supported in default-server: Yes
7466
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007467send-proxy
7468 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7469 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7470 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7471 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7472 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7473 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7474 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7475 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7476 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007477 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7478 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7479 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7480 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7481 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007482
7483 Supported in default-server: No
7484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007485slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007486 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7487 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7488 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7489 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7490 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7491 parameters :
7492
7493 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7494 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7495
7496 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7497 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7498 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7499 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7500
7501 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7502 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7503 seen as failed.
7504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007505 Supported in default-server: Yes
7506
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007507source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007508source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007509source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007510 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7511 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7512 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7513 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7514
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007515 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7516 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7517 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7518 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7519 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7520 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7521 server.
7522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007523 Supported in default-server: No
7524
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007525ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007526 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7527 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7528 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7529 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7530 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7531 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7532 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7533 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7534
7535 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007537track [<proxy>/]<server>
7538 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7539 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7540 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7541 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7542 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007544 Supported in default-server: No
7545
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007546verify [none|required]
7547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7548 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7549 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7550 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7551 is aborted.
7552
7553 Supported in default-server: No
7554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007555weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007556 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7557 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7558 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007559 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7560 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7561 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7562 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7563 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7564 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007566 Supported in default-server: Yes
7567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007568
75696. HTTP header manipulation
7570---------------------------
7571
7572In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7573response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7574request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7575which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7576against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7577to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7578passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7579headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7580never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7581
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007582There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7583(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7584rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7585messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7586in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007587happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007588add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7589normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007591This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7592in section 4.2 :
7593
7594 - reqadd <string>
7595 - reqallow <search>
7596 - reqiallow <search>
7597 - reqdel <search>
7598 - reqidel <search>
7599 - reqdeny <search>
7600 - reqideny <search>
7601 - reqpass <search>
7602 - reqipass <search>
7603 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7604 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7605 - reqtarpit <search>
7606 - reqitarpit <search>
7607 - rspadd <string>
7608 - rspdel <search>
7609 - rspidel <search>
7610 - rspdeny <search>
7611 - rspideny <search>
7612 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7613 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7614
7615With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7616is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7617parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7618prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7619Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7620
7621 \t for a tab
7622 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7623 \n for a new line (LF)
7624 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7625 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7626 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7627 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7628 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7629
7630The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7631portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7632above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7633regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
76349 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7635is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7636
7637The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7638after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7639
7640Notes related to these keywords :
7641---------------------------------
7642 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7643 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7644 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7645
7646 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7647 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7648 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7649
7650 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7651 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7652 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7653 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7654 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7655
7656 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7657 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7658 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7659 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7660 useless headers before adding new ones.
7661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007662 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7664
7665 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7666 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7667 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7668
7669 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7670 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007671 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007672
7673
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010076747. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7675------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007676
7677The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7678content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7679from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7680simple :
7681
7682 - define test criteria with sets of values
7683 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7684
7685The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7686
7687In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7688
7689 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7690
7691This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7692Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7693and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7694an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7695of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7696
7697ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7698'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7699which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7700
7701There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7702performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7703
7704The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7705
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007706 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7707 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007708 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7709
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007710The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7711specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7712possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007713multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7714be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7715needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7716space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7717match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7718lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7719duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007720to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007721instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007722
7723 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7724
7725In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7726the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7727case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7728too.
7729
7730Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7731a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7732ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007734Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007736 - integers or integer ranges
7737 - strings
7738 - regular expressions
7739 - IP addresses and networks
7740
7741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077427.1. Matching integers
7743----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007744
7745Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7746that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7747expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7748may be omitted.
7749
7750For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7751unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7752representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7753
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007754As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7755two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7756instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7757ranges and operators.
7758
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007759For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007760operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7761Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7762of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007764Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007765
7766 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7767 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7768 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7769 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7770 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007772For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007773
7774 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7775
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007776This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7777
7778 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7779
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077817.2. Matching strings
7782---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007783
7784String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7785exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7786characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7787string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7788to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007789before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007790
7791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077927.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7793-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007794
7795Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7796they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7797possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7798passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7799the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007800the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7801match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007802
7803
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020078047.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007805----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007806
7807IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7808netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7809within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007810host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007811difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7812at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7813does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7814parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007815
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007816IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7817Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7818trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7819IPv6 patterns.
7820
7821HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7822following situations :
7823 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7824 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7825 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7826 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7827 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7828 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7829 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7830 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7831 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7832 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7833
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078357.5. Available matching criteria
7836--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078387.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7839------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007840
7841A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7842analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007843addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007844
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007845always_false
7846 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7847 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7848
7849always_true
7850 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7851 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7852
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007853avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007854avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007855 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7856 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7857 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7858 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7859 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7860 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7861 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7862 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7863 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7864 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7865 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007866
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007867be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007868be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007869 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7870 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7871 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7872 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7873 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007874
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007875be_id <integer>
7876 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7877 backend it was called.
7878
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007879be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007880be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007881 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7882 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7883 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7884 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7885 sucking of an online dictionary).
7886
7887 Example :
7888 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7889 backend dynamic
7890 mode http
7891 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7892 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007893
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007894connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007895connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007896 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007897 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007898 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7899
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007900 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7901 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007902
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007903 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007904 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7905 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7906 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7907 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7908 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007909 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007910
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007911 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7912 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7913 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7914 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007915
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007916dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007917 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7918 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920dst_conn <integer>
7921 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7922 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7923 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7924 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7925 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7926 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7927
7928dst_port <integer>
7929 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7930 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7931
7932fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007933fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007934 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7935 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7936 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7937 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7938 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7939 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7940 criteria.
7941
7942fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007943 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007944 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007945
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007946fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007947fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007948 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7949 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7950 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7951 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7952 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7953 the rate to go down below the limit.
7954
7955 Example :
7956 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7957 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7958 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7959 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7960 frontend mail
7961 bind :25
7962 mode tcp
7963 maxconn 100
7964 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7965 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7966 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7967 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007968
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007969nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007970nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007971 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7972 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7973 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7974 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7975 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007976
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007977queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007978queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007979 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7980 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7981 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7982 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7983 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7984 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7985 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7986
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007987sc1_bytes_in_rate
7988sc2_bytes_in_rate
7989 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7990 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7991 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7992
7993sc1_bytes_out_rate
7994sc2_bytes_out_rate
7995 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7996 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7997 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7998
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007999sc1_clr_gpc0
8000sc2_clr_gpc0
8001 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8002 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8003 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8004 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8005 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8006 was verified :
8007
8008 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8009 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8010 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8011 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8012 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8013 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8014 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008016sc1_conn_cnt
8017sc2_conn_cnt
8018 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8019 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8020
8021sc1_conn_cur
8022sc2_conn_cur
8023 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8024 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8025 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8026
8027sc1_conn_rate
8028sc2_conn_rate
8029 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8030 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8031 See also src_conn_rate.
8032
8033sc1_get_gpc0
8034sc2_get_gpc0
8035 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8036 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8037
8038sc1_http_err_cnt
8039sc2_http_err_cnt
8040 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8041 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8042 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8043
8044sc1_http_err_rate
8045sc2_http_err_rate
8046 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8047 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8048 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8049 src_http_err_rate.
8050
8051sc1_http_req_cnt
8052sc2_http_req_cnt
8053 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8054 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8055 src_http_req_cnt.
8056
8057sc1_http_req_rate
8058sc2_http_req_rate
8059 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8060 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8061 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8062 src_http_req_rate.
8063
8064sc1_inc_gpc0
8065sc2_inc_gpc0
8066 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8067 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8068 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8069 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8070 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8071 when a first ACL was verified :
8072
8073 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8074 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8075 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8076
8077sc1_kbytes_in
8078sc2_kbytes_in
8079 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8080 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8081 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8082 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8083
8084sc1_kbytes_out
8085sc2_kbytes_out
8086 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8087 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8088 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8089 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8090
8091sc1_sess_cnt
8092sc2_sess_cnt
8093 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8094 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8095 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8096 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008097 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008098 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8099
8100sc1_sess_rate
8101sc2_sess_rate
8102 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8103 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8104 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8105 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8106 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008107 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008108
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008109so_id <integer>
8110 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8111
8112src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008113 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8114 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8115 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008116
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008117src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008118src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008119 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8120 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8121 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008122 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008123
8124src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008125src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008126 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8127 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8128 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008129 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008130
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008131src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8132src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8133 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8134 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8135 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8136 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8137 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8138 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8139
8140 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8141 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8142 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8143 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8144 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8145 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8146 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8147
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008148src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008149src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008150 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8151 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8152 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008153 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008154
8155src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008156src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008157 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8158 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8159 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008160 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008161
8162src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008163src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008164 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8165 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8166 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008167 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008168
8169src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008170src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008171 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8172 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8173 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008174 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008175
8176src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008177src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008178 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8179 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8180 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008181 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008182
8183src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008184src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008185 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8186 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8187 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8188 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008189 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008190
8191src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008192src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008193 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8194 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8195 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008196 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008197
8198src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008199src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008200 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8201 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8202 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8203 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008204 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008205
8206src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008207src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008208 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8209 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8210 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8211 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8212 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8213 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8214
8215 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8216 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008217 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008218
8219src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008220src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008221 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8222 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8223 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8224 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008225 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008226
8227src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008228src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008229 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8230 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8231 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8232 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008233 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008234
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008235src_port <integer>
8236 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008237
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008238src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008239src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008240 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8241 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8242 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8243 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008244 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008245
8246src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008247src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008248 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8249 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8250 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8251 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008252 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008253
8254src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008255src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008256 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008257 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8258 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008259 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8260 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8261 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008262 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008263
8264 Example :
8265 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8266 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8267 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8268 listen ssh
8269 bind :22
8270 mode tcp
8271 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008272 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008273 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8274 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8275
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008276srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008277 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8278 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8279 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8280 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8281
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008282srv_id <integer>
8283 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8284
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008285srv_is_up(<server>)
8286srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8287 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8288 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8289 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8290 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8291 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8292 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8293 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8294 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8295
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008296table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008297table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008298 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8299 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8300
8301table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008302table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008303 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8304 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8305 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020083087.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8309---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008310
8311A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8312during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008313through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8314keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008315
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008316rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8317 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8318 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8319 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008320 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8321 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8322 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008323
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008324req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008325 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008326 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8327 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8328 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8329 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8330 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8331 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8332
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008333req_proto_http
8334 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8335 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008336 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008337 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8338 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8339
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008340req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008341req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008342 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8343 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8344 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8345 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8346 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8347 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8348 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8349 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8350
8351req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008352req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008353 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8354 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8355 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8356 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8357 cookies.
8358
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008359req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8360 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8361 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8362 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008363 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8364 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8365 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008366
8367req_ssl_sni <string>
8368 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8369 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8370 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8371 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8372 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8373 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8374 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008375 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8376 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008377 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008378 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008379
8380 Examples :
8381 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8382 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8383 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8384 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8385 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8386
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008387req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8388 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8389 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8390 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8391 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8392 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8393 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008394 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8395 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008396 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008397 option.
8398
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008399ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8400 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8401 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8402 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8403 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8404 during this verification process.
8405
8406ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8407 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8408 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8409 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8410 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8411
8412ssl_c_err <integer>
8413 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8414 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8415 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8416 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8417
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008418ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8419ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8420 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8421 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8422 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8423 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8424 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8425 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8426 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8427 DN matches the specified string.
8428
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008429ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8430 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8431 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8432 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8433
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008434ssl_c_notafter <string>
8435 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8436 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8437 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8438
8439ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8440 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8441 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8442 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8443
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008444ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8445ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8446 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8447 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8448 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8449 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8450 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8451 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8452 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8453 DN matches the specified string.
8454
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008455ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8456 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8457 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8458 the value written in hexa.
8459
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008460ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8461 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8462 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8463 by the client matches the string.
8464
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008465ssl_c_verify <integer>
8466 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8467 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8468 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8469
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008470ssl_c_version <integer>
8471 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8472 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8473 the value.
8474
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008475ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8476ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8477 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8478 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8479 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8480 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8481 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8482 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8483 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8484 DN matches the specified string.
8485
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008486ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8487 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8488 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8489 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8490
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008491ssl_f_notafter <string>
8492 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8493 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8494 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8495
8496ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8497 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8498 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8499 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8500
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008501ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8502ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8503 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8504 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8505 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8506 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8507 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8508 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8509 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8510 DN matches the specified string.
8511
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008512ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8513 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8514 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8515 the value written in hexa.
8516
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008517ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8518 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8519 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8520 by the frontend matches the string.
8521
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008522ssl_f_version <integer>
8523 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8524 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8525 the value.
8526
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008527ssl_fc
8528 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8529 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8530 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8531
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008532ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8533 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8534 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8535
8536ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8537 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8538 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8539
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008540ssl_fc_has_crt
8541 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8542 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8543
8544ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008545 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008546 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8547 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8548 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8549 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008550
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008551ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008552 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8553 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8554 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8555 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008556 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8557 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8558 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008559
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008560ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8561 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8562 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8563
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008564ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008565 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8566 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8567 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8568 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008569 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8570 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008571 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8572 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8573 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008574
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008575ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008576 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8577 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8578 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8579 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008580 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8581 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8582 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8583 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008584
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008585ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008586 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8587 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8588 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8589 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008590 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8591 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8592 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8593 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008594
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008595ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8596 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8597 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8598
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008599wait_end
8600 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8601 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8602 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8603 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8604 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8605 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8606 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8607 inspection.
8608
8609 Examples :
8610 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8611 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8612 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8613
8614 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8615 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8616 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8617 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8618 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8619 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8620 tcp-request content reject
8621
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086237.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8624--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008625
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008626A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008627application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8628read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8629than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8630
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008631base <string>
8632 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8633 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8634 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8635 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8636 See also "path" and "uri".
8637
8638base_beg <string>
8639 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8640 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8641 "path_beg".
8642
8643base_dir <string>
8644 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8645 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8646 "path_dir" instead.
8647
8648base_dom <string>
8649 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8650 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8651 instead.
8652
8653base_end <string>
8654 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8655 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8656
8657base_len <integer>
8658 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8659 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8660
8661base_reg <regex>
8662 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8663 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8664 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8665 and all "base_" criteria.
8666
8667base_sub <string>
8668 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8669 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8670 also "base_dir".
8671
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008672cook(<name>) <string>
8673 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8674 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8675 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8676 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8677 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8678 sent by the server.
8679
8680 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8681 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8682 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8683
8684 cook(profile) silver gold
8685
8686cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8687 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8688 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8689 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8690
8691cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8692 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8693 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8694 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8695 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8696 server.
8697
8698cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8699 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8700 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8701 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8702 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8703 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8704
8705cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8706 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8707 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8708 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8709 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8710
8711cook_end(<name>) <string>
8712 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8713 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8714 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8715
8716cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8717 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8718 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8719 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8720 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8721 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8722
8723cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8724 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8725 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8726 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8727 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8728 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8729
8730cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8731 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8732 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8733 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8734
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008735cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8736 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8737 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8738 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8739 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8740 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8741
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008742hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008743hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008744 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8745 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8746 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8747 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008748 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8749 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8750 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8751 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8752 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008753
8754 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008755 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008756 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8757
8758 hdr(Connection) -i close
8759
8760hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008761hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008762 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8763 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8764 response headers sent by the server.
8765
8766hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008767hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008768 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8769 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8770 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8771 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8772 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8773 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8774 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8775
8776hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008777hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008778 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8779 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8780 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8781 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8782 headers sent by the server.
8783
8784hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008785hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008786 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8787 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8788 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8789 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8790 server.
8791
8792hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008793hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008794 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8795 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8796 response headers sent by the server.
8797
8798hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008799hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8800 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8801 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8802 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008803 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8804
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008805hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008806hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008807 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8808 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8809 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8810 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8811
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008812hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008813hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008814 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008815 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8816 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8817 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8818 response headers sent by the server.
8819
8820hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008821hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8823 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8824 response headers sent by the server.
8825
8826hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008827hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008828 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8829 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8830 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8831 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8832
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008833http_auth(<userlist>)
8834http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008835 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8836 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8837 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8838 of specified groups.
8839
8840 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8841
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008842http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008843 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8844 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8845 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8846 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8847
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008848method <string>
8849 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8850 already check for most common methods.
8851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008852path <string>
8853 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8854 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8855 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8856
8857path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008858 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8859 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008860
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008861path_dir <string>
8862 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8863 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8864 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8865 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8866
8867path_dom <string>
8868 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8869 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8870 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8871
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008872path_end <string>
8873 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8874 control file name extension.
8875
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008876path_len <integer>
8877 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8878 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8879
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008880path_reg <regex>
8881 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8882 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8883 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8884
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008885path_sub <string>
8886 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8887 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8888 "path_dir".
8889
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008890payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8891 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8892 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8893 strings.
8894
8895payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8896 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8897 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8898 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8899 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8900 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8901
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008902req_ver <string>
8903 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8904 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8905
8906status <integer>
8907 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8908 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8909 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8910
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008911url <string>
8912 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008913 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008914
8915url_beg <string>
8916 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008917 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8918 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008919
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008920url_dir <string>
8921 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8922 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8923 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8924 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8925
8926url_dom <string>
8927 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8928 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8929 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008931url_end <string>
8932 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8933 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008934
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008935url_ip <address>
8936 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8937 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8938 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008939
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008940url_len <integer>
8941 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8942 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8943
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008944url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008945 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8946 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008947 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008948 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008949
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950url_reg <regex>
8951 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8952 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008953 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008955url_sub <string>
8956 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8957 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008958
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008959urlp(<name>) <string>
8960 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8961 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8962
8963 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8964 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8965
8966urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8967 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8968 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8969 protocol scheme.
8970
8971urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8972 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8973 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8974 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8975 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8976
8977urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8978 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8979 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8980 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8981 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8982
8983urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8984 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8985
8986urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008987 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8988 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008989
8990urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8991 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8992 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8993
8994urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8995 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8996 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8997 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8998 "urlp_" criteria.
8999
9000urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9001 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9002 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9003 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9004
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009005urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9006 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9007 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9008 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9009 negative data.
9010
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090127.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9013---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009015Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9016every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009017order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009019ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9020---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009021FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009022HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009023HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9024HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009025HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9026HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9027HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9028HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9029LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009030METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9031METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9032METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9033METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9034METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9035METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009036RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009037REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009038TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009039WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9040---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009041
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090437.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9044----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009046Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9047combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009049 - AND (implicit)
9050 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9051 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009053A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009055 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009057Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9058indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009060For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9061"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9062requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9063is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009065 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9066 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9067 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9068 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009070To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9071and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009073 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9074 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9075 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9076 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009078 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9079 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9080 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9081 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009082
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009083It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9084expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9085be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009086the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009087
9088 The following rule :
9089
9090 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9091 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9092
9093 Can also be written that way :
9094
9095 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9096
9097It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9098to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9099simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9100sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9101good use is the following :
9102
9103 With named ACLs :
9104
9105 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9106 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9107 monitor fail if site_dead
9108
9109 With anonymous ACLs :
9110
9111 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009113See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009114
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009115
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010091167.8. Pattern extraction
9117-----------------------
9118
9119The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9120response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9121for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9122
9123All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9124"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9125begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9126arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9127much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9128equivalent used in ACLs.
9129
9130The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9131
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009132 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9133 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9134 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9135 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9136 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9137 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9138 requested objects by host/path.
9139
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009140 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009141 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9142 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9143 according to RFC 4291.
9144
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009145 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9146 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9147 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009148 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9149 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9150 according to RFC 4291.
9151
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009152 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9153 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9154 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9155 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9156 type integer and only works with such tables.
9157
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009158 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9159 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9160 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9161 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9162 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9163 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9164 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009165 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009166
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009167 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9168 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9169 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9170 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9171 wiser to use "url" instead.
9172
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009173 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009174 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9175 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9176 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9177 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009178
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009179 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009180 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9181 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9182 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9183 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9184 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9185 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9186 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9187 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009188
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009189 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9190 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9191 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9192 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9193
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009194 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9195 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9196
9197 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9198 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9199 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9200
9201 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9202 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9203
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009204 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9205 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9206 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9207 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9208 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9209 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9210 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9211 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9212 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9213 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9214 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9215
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009216 ssl_c_key_alg
9217 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9218 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9219 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9220
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009221 ssl_c_notafter
9222 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9223 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9224 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9225
9226 ssl_c_notbefore
9227 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9228 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9229 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9230
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009231 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9232 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9233 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9234 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9235 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9236 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9237 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9238 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9239 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9240 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9241 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9242
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009243 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9244 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9245 layer.
9246
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009247 ssl_c_sig_alg
9248 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9249 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9250 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9251
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009252 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9253 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9254 error is encountered.
9255
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009256 ssl_c_version
9257 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9258 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9259 layer.
9260
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009261 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9262 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9263 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9264 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9265 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9266 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9267 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9268 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9269 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9270 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9271 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9272
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009273 ssl_f_key_alg
9274 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9275 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9276 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9277
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009278 ssl_f_notafter
9279 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9280 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9281 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9282
9283 ssl_f_notbefore
9284 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9285 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9286 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9287
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009288 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9289 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9290 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9291 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9292 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9293 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9294 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9295 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9296 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9297 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9298 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9299
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009300 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9301 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9302 layer.
9303
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009304 ssl_f_sig_alg
9305 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9306 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9307 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9308
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009309 ssl_f_version
9310 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9311 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9312 layer.
9313
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009314 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9315 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9316 otherwise zero.
9317
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009318 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9319 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9320 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9321
9322 ssl_fc_cipher
9323 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9324 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9325
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009326 ssl_fc_has_crt
9327 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9328 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9329
9330 ssl_fc_has_sni
9331 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009332 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9333 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009334 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009335 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009336
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009337 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009338 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9339 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9340 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9341 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009342 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009343
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009344 ssl_fc_protocol
9345 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection
9346 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9347
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009348 ssl_fc_session_id
9349 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9350 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9351 stick on a given client.
9352
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009353 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009354 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9355 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9356 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9357 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9358 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009359
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009360 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9361 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9362 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9363
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009364 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9365 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9366 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9367 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9368
9369 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9370 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9371 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9372 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9373 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9374 table for a given source address.
9375
9376 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9377 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9378
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009379 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009380 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009381 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9382 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9383 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9384 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9385 where cookies cannot be used.
9386
9387 Example :
9388 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9389 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9390 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9391 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009392
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009393 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009394 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9395 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9396 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9397 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009398
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009399 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9400 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9401 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9402 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9403 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9404 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9405 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009406
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009407 Example :
9408 listen tse-farm
9409 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9410 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9411 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9412 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9413 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9414 persist rdp-cookie
9415 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9416 # This is only useful makes sense if
9417 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9418 stick-table type string size 204800
9419 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9420 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9421 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009422
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009423 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9424 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009425
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009426 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009427 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009428 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9429 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9430 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9431 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9432 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9433 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009434
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009435 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009436
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009437 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009438 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9439 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9440 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9441
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009442 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9443 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9444 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9445 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9446 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009447
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009448 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009449
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009450
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009451The currently available list of transformations include :
9452
9453 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9454 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9455 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9456
9457 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9458 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9459 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9460
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009461 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009462 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9463 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9464 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9465 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9466
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094688. Logging
9469----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009471One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9472provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9473very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9474provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9475state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009476to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009477headers.
9478
9479In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9480about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9481send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9482
9483 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9484 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9485 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9486 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9487 at the termination.
9488
9489The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9490allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9491as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9492while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9493real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9494delay.
9495
9496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094978.1. Log levels
9498---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009499
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009500TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009501source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009502HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9503in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9504track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9505syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9506about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009507
9508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095098.2. Log formats
9510----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009511
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009512HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009513and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9514slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9515options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009516
9517 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9518 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9519 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9520 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9521 extents.
9522
9523 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9524 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9525 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9526 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9527 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9528
9529 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9530 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9531 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9532 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9533 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9534
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009535 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9536 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9537 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9538 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9539
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009540 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009542Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9543specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9544field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9545servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9546always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9547identifier.
9548
9549Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9550 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9551 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9552 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9553 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9554
9555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095568.2.1. Default log format
9557-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009558
9559This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9560as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9561format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9562
9563 Example :
9564 listen www
9565 mode http
9566 log global
9567 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9568
9569 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9570 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9571 (www/HTTP)
9572
9573 Field Format Extract from the example above
9574 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9575 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9576 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9577 4 'to' to
9578 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9579 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9580
9581Detailed fields description :
9582 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9583 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9584 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9585 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9586 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9587 and processed the connection.
9588 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9589
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009590In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9591"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9592connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9593
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009594It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9595will eventually disappear.
9596
9597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095988.2.2. TCP log format
9599---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009600
9601The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9602is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9603information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9604counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9605emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9606environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9607the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9608sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009609specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9610not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9611fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9612marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009613
9614 Example :
9615 frontend fnt
9616 mode tcp
9617 option tcplog
9618 log global
9619 default_backend bck
9620
9621 backend bck
9622 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9623
9624 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9625 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9626 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9627
9628 Field Format Extract from the example above
9629 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9630 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9631 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9632 4 frontend_name fnt
9633 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9634 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9635 7 bytes_read* 212
9636 8 termination_state --
9637 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9638 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9639
9640Detailed fields description :
9641 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009642 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9643 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9644 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9645 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9646 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009647
9648 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009649 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9650 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9651 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009652
9653 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9654 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9655 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9656 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9657
9658 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9659 and processed the connection.
9660
9661 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9662 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9663 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9664 applications.
9665
9666 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9667 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9668 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9669 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9670 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9671
9672 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9673 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9674 See "Timers" below for more details.
9675
9676 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9677 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9678 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9679 "Timers" below for more details.
9680
9681 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9682 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9683 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9684 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9685 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9686 details.
9687
9688 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9689 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9690 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9691 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9692 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9693
9694 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9695 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9696 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9697 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9698 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9699 for more details.
9700
9701 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009702 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009703 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9704 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9705 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009706 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009707
9708 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9709 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9710 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9711 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9712 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9713 caused by a denial of service attack.
9714
9715 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9716 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9717 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9718 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9719 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9720 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9721 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9722 denial of service attack.
9723
9724 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9725 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9726 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9727 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9728 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9729 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9730 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9731 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9732 be processed than on other servers.
9733
9734 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9735 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9736 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9737 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9738 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9739 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9740 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9741 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9742 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9743 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9744 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9745 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9746 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9747
9748 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9749 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9750 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9751 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9752 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9753 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9754 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9755 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9756
9757 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9758 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9759 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9760 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9761 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9762 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9763 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9764 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9765 occurs.
9766
9767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097688.2.3. HTTP log format
9769----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009770
9771The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9772is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9773the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9774are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9775emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9776generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9777"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9778which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009779frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9780is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009781
9782Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9783slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9784with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9785
9786 Example :
9787 frontend http-in
9788 mode http
9789 option httplog
9790 log global
9791 default_backend bck
9792
9793 backend static
9794 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9795
9796 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9797 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9798 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009799 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009800
9801 Field Format Extract from the example above
9802 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9803 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9804 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9805 4 frontend_name http-in
9806 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9807 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9808 7 status_code 200
9809 8 bytes_read* 2750
9810 9 captured_request_cookie -
9811 10 captured_response_cookie -
9812 11 termination_state ----
9813 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9814 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9815 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9816 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9817 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009818
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009819
9820Detailed fields description :
9821 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009822 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9823 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9824 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9825 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9826 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009827
9828 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009829 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9830 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9831 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009832
9833 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9834 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9835 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9836 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9837 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9838
9839 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9840 and processed the connection.
9841
9842 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9843 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9844 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9845
9846 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9847 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9848 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9849 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9850 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9851 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9852
9853 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9854 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9855 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9856 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9857 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9858 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9859
9860 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9861 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9862 See "Timers" below for more details.
9863
9864 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9865 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9866 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9867 below for more details.
9868
9869 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9870 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9871 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9872 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9873 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9874 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9875 for more details.
9876
9877 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9878 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9879 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9880 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9881 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9882 details.
9883
9884 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9885 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9886 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9887
9888 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9889 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9890 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9891 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9892 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9893 overflowing.
9894
9895 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9896 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9897 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9898 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9899 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9900 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9901 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9902 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9903
9904 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9905 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9906 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9907 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9908 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9909 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9910 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9911 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9912
9913 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9914 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9915 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9916 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9917 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9918 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9919 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9920
9921 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009922 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009923 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9924 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9925 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009926 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009927 system.
9928
9929 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9930 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9931 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9932 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9933 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9934 caused by a denial of service attack.
9935
9936 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9937 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9938 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9939 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9940 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9941 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9942 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9943 denial of service attack.
9944
9945 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9946 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9947 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9948 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9949 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9950 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9951 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9952 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9953 processed than on other servers.
9954
9955 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9956 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9957 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9958 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9959 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9960 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9961 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9962 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9963 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9964 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9965 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9966 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9967 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9968
9969 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9970 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9971 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9972 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9973 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9974 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9975 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9976 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9977
9978 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9979 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9980 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9981 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9982 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9983 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9984 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9985 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9986 occurs.
9987
9988 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9989 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9990 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9991 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9992 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9993 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9994 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9995 cookies" below for more details.
9996
9997 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9998 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9999 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10000 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10001 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10002 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10003 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10004 and cookies" below for more details.
10005
10006 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10007 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10008 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10009 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10010 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10011 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10012 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10013 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10014
10015
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200100168.2.4. Custom log format
10017------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010018
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010019The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10020mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010021
10022HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10023Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10024separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10025prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10026
10027Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10028variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10029string formats ("Q").
10030
10031Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10032HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10033
10034Flags are :
10035 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010036 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010037
10038 Example:
10039
10040 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10041 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10042
10043At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10044
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010045 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010046 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010047
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010048the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010049
10050 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010051 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010052 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10053
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010054and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10055
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010056 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010057 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10058
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010059Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10060
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010061 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010062 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010063 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10064 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10065 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10066 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010067 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010068 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010069 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010070 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010071 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10072 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10073 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010074 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010075 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10076 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10077 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010078 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010079 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010080 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10081 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010082 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010083 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10084 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10085 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10086 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10087 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10088 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010089 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10090 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10091 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010092 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010093 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010094 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010095 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10096 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10097 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10098 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010099 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010100 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010101 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010102 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10103 | | %s | server_name | string |
10104 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10105 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010106 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10107 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10108 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010109 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010110 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010111 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010112 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010113
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010114 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101168.3. Advanced logging options
10117-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010118
10119Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10120just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10121options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10122for more information about their usage.
10123
10124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10126------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010127
10128It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10129haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10130commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10131monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10132ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10133
10134 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10135 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10136 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10137 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10138
10139 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10140 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10141 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10142 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10143 such as other load-balancers.
10144
10145 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10146 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10147 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10148
10149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10151----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010152
10153The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10154what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10155or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10156"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10157just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10158log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10159after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10160is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10161with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10162with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10163
10164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10166------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010167
10168Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10169for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10170"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10171retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10172raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10173a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10174file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10175you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10176"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10177
10178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10180--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010181
10182Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10183multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10184them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10185"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10186logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10187error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10188and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10189too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10190useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10191alternative.
10192
10193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101948.4. Timing events
10195------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010196
10197Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10198reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10199the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10200frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10201mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10202
10203 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10204 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10205 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10206 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10207 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10208
10209 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10210 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10211 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10212 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10213 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10214
10215 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10216 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10217 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10218 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10219 connection never established.
10220
10221 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10222 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10223 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10224 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10225 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10226 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10227 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10228 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10229 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10230 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10231 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10232
10233 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10234 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10235 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10236 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10237 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10238
10239 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10240
10241 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10242 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10243 negative.
10244
10245These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10246protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10247that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010248due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010249close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10250session has been aborted on timeout.
10251
10252Most common cases :
10253
10254 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10255 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10256 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10257 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10258 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10259 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10260 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10261 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10262 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010263 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10264 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10265 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010266
10267 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10268 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10269 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10270 of ms on remote networks.
10271
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010272 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10273 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10274 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010275
10276 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10277 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10278 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10279 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10280 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10281 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10282 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10283 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10284 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10285 to the server until another one is released.
10286
10287Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10288
10289 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10290 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10291 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10292
10293 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10294 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10295 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10296
10297 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10298 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10299 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10300 flags.
10301
10302 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10303 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10304 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10305 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10306 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10307 the client connection was maintained open.
10308
10309 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10310 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10311 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10312 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10313
10314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103158.5. Session state at disconnection
10316-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010317
10318TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10319"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10321each of which has a special meaning :
10322
10323 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10324 session to terminate :
10325
10326 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10327
10328 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10329 server explicitly refused it.
10330
10331 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10332 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10333 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10334 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10335 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10336 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10337
10338 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10339 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10340 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10341 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10342 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10343
10344 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10345 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10346 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10347 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10348 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10349
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010350 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10351 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10352
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010353 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10354 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10355 backup connections when going up.
10356
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010357 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010359 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10360 send or receive data.
10361
10362 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10363 send or receive data.
10364
10365 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10366 with nothing left in the buffers.
10367
10368 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10369
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010370 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010371 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10372
10373 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10374 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10375 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10376 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10377 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10378
10379 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10380 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10381
10382 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10383 server (HTTP only).
10384
10385 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10386
10387 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10388 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10389 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10390
10391 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10392 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10393 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10394
10395 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10396
10397 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10398 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10399
10400 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10401 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10402 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10403
10404 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10405 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010406 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10407 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010408
10409 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10410 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10411 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10412 another server.
10413
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010414 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010415 server.
10416
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010417 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10418 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10419 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10420 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10421
10422 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10423 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10424 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10425 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10426
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010427 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10428 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10429 "use-server" rule).
10430
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010431 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10432
10433 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10434 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10435
10436 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10437
10438 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10439 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10440 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10441
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010442 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10443 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10444 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10445 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10446 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10447
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010448 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10449
10450 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10451 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10452
10453 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10454
10455 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10456
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010457The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10458was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010459helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10460starvation, attacks, etc...
10461
10462The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10463alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10464easier finding and understanding.
10465
10466 Flags Reason
10467
10468 -- Normal termination.
10469
10470 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10471 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10472 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10473 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10474
10475 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10476 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10477 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10478 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10479 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10480 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010481
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010482 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10483 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010484 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010485
10486 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10487 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10488 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10489
10490 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10491 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10492 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10493 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10494 the server takes too long to respond.
10495
10496 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10497 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10498 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10499 long a time to respond.
10500
10501 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10502 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10503 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10504 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10505 and the client.
10506
10507 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10508 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10509 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10510 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10511 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10512 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10513
10514 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10515 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010516 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10517 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10518 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10519 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010521 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010522 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10523 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10524 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10525 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10526 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10527
10528 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10529 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10530 503 or 504 here.
10531
10532 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10533 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10534 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10535 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10536 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10537
10538 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10539 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010540 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010541 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10542 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10543
10544 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10545 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10546 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10547 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10548 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10549 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10550 between haproxy and the server.
10551
10552 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10553 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10554 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10555 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10556 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10557 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10558 solution is to fix the application.
10559
10560 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10561 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10562 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10563 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10564 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10565 external attacks.
10566
10567 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10568 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010569 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010570 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10571 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10572
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010573 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10574 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10575 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10576 the client.
10577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010578 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10579 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10580 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10581 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010582 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10583 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10584 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10585 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10586 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010587
10588 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10589 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10590 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10591 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10592
10593 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10594 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10595 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10596 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10597
10598 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10599 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10600 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10601 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10602
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010603The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10604persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10605important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10606re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10607
10608 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10609
10610 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10611 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10612 set on a GET request.
10613
10614 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10615 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010616 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010617 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10618
10619 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10620 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10621 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10622
10623 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10624 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10625 already got a cookie.
10626
10627 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10628 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10629 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10630 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10631 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10632
10633 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10634 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10635 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10636
10637 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10638 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10639 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10640
10641 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10642 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10643
10644 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10645 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10646 then advertised in the response.
10647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106498.6. Non-printable characters
10650-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010651
10652In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10653consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10654converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10655prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10656being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10657escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10658is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10659'}' when logging headers.
10660
10661Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10662issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10663containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10664
10665Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10666the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10667performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10668
10669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106708.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10671---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010672
10673Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10674achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010675section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010676cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10677the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10678the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010679locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010680not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10681user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10682a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10683wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10684
10685 Examples :
10686 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10687 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10688
10689 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10690 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10691
10692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106938.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10694---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010695
10696Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10697proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10698the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10699server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10700
10701Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10702response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010703section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010704
10705It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010706time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10707appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010708are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10709and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10710follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10711request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10712in the logs.
10713
10714 Example :
10715 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10716 listen proxy-out
10717 mode http
10718 option httplog
10719 option logasap
10720 log global
10721 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10722
10723 # log the name of the virtual server
10724 capture request header Host len 20
10725
10726 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10727 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10728
10729 # log the beginning of the referrer
10730 capture request header Referer len 20
10731
10732 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10733 capture response header Server len 20
10734
10735 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10736 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10737
10738 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10739 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10740
10741 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10742 capture response header Via len 20
10743
10744 # log the URL location during a redirection
10745 capture response header Location len 20
10746
10747 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10748 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10749 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10750 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10751 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10752
10753 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10754 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10755 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10756 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010757 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010758
10759 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10760 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10761 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10762 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10763 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010764 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010765
10766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107678.9. Examples of logs
10768---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010769
10770These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10771them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10772reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10773
10774 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10775 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10776 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10777
10778 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10779 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10780
10781 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10782 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10783 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10784
10785 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10786 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10787
10788 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10789 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10790 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10791
10792 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010793 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010794 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10795 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10796
10797 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10798 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10799 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10800
10801 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10802 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010803 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010804 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10805 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10806 to return the 502 and not the server.
10807
10808 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010809 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010810
10811 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10812 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10813 Nothing was sent to any server.
10814
10815 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10816 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10817
10818 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10819 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10820 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10821 send a 408 return code to the client.
10822
10823 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10824 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10825
10826 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10827 5 seconds ("c----").
10828
10829 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10830 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010831 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010832
10833 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010834 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010835 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10836 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10837 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10838 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10839 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010840
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108429. Statistics and monitoring
10843----------------------------
10844
10845It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10846mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10847CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10848Unix socket.
10849
10850
108519.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010852---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010853
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010854The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10855page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010857 0. pxname: proxy name
10858 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10859 for server)
10860 2. qcur: current queued requests
10861 3. qmax: max queued requests
10862 4. scur: current sessions
10863 5. smax: max sessions
10864 6. slim: sessions limit
10865 7. stot: total sessions
10866 8. bin: bytes in
10867 9. bout: bytes out
10868 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010869 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010870 12. ereq: request errors
10871 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010872 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010873 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10874 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010875 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010876 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10877 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10878 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10879 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10880 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10881 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10882 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10883 25. qlimit: queue limit
10884 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10885 27. iid: unique proxy id
10886 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10887 29. throttle: warm up status
10888 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10889 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010890 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010891 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10892 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10893 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010894 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010895 UNK -> unknown
10896 INI -> initializing
10897 SOCKERR -> socket error
10898 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10899 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10900 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10901 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10902 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10903 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10904 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10905 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10906 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10907 disable-on-404
10908 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10909 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10910 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010911 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10912 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010913 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10914 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10915 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10916 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10917 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10918 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010919 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10920 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10921 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10922 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010923 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10924 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010925
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109279.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010928-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010929
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010930The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010931must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10932is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10933a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10934risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10935followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10936given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10937then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10938to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010939
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010940It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10941on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10942own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010944clear counters
10945 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10946 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10947 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10948 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10949 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10950
10951clear counters all
10952 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10953 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10954 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10955
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010956clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10957 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10958
10959 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10960 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10961 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10962 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10963 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10964 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10965
10966 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10967
10968 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10969 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10970 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10971 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10972 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10973 the ACLs :
10974
10975 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10976 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10977 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10978 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10979 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10980 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10981
10982 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010983 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10984 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010985
10986 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010987 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010988 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010989 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10990 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10991 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10992 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010993
10994 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10995
10996 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010997 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010998 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10999 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011000 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11001 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11002 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011003
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011004disable frontend <frontend>
11005 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11006 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11007 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11008 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11009 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11010 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11011 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11012 on the stats page.
11013
11014 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11015 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11016
11017 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11018 level "admin".
11019
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011020disable server <backend>/<server>
11021 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11022 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11023 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11024 during the maintenance.
11025
11026 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11027 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11028
11029 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011030 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011031
11032 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11033 level "admin".
11034
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011035enable frontend <frontend>
11036 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11037 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11038 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11039 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11040 which was disabled.
11041
11042 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11043 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11044
11045 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11046 level "admin".
11047
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011048enable server <backend>/<server>
11049 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11050 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11051
11052 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011053 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011054
11055 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11056 level "admin".
11057
11058get weight <backend>/<server>
11059 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11060 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11061 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11062 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11063 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011064 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011065
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011066help
11067 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11068 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011069
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011070prompt
11071 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11072 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11073 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11074 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11075 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11076 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11077 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11078 command.
11079
11080quit
11081 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011082
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011083set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011084 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11085 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11086 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11087 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11088 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011089 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11090 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11091
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011092set maxconn global <maxconn>
11093 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11094 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11095 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11096 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11097 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11098 setting.
11099
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011100set rate-limit connections global <value>
11101 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11102 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11103 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11104 is passed in number of connections per second.
11105
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011106set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11107 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11108 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11109 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11110 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11111 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11112
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011113set timeout cli <delay>
11114 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11115 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11116 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11117
11118set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11119 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11120 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11121 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11122 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11123 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11124 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11125 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11126 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11127 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11128 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11129 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11130 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11131 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011132 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011133
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011134show errors [<iid>]
11135 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11136 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011137 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11138 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11139 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011140
11141 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11142 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11143 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11144 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11145 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11146 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11147 are reported too.
11148
11149 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11150 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11151 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11152 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11153 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11154 code.
11155
11156 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11157 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11158 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11159 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11160 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11161 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11162 line.
11163
11164 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011165 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11166 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011167 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11168 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11169
11170 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11171 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11172 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11173 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11174 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11175 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11176 00204+ minal\r\n
11177 00211 \r\n
11178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011179 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011180 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11181 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11182 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11183 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11184 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11185 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011186
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011187show info
11188 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11189
11190show sess
11191 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011192 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11193 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11194
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011195show sess <id>
11196 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11197 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11198 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11199 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11200 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11201 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011202
11203show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11204 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11205 possible to dump only selected items :
11206 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11207 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11208 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11209 for example:
11210 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11211 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11212 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11213
11214 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011215 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11216 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011217 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11218 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11219 Nbproc: 1
11220 Process_num: 1
11221 (...)
11222
11223 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11224 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11225 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11226 (...)
11227 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11228
11229 $
11230
11231 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11232 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11233 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11234 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011235 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011236
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011237show table
11238 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11239 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11240 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11241 entries currently in use.
11242
11243 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011244 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011245 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11246 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011247
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011248show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011249 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11250 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11251 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011252 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11253
11254 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11255 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11256 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11257 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11258 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11259
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011260 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11261 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11262 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11263 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11264 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11265 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11266
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011267
11268 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011269 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11270 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011271
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011272 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011273 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011274 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011275 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11276 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11277 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11278 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011279
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011280 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011281 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011282 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11283 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011284
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011285 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11286 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011287 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011288 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11289 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011290
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011291 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11292 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011293 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011294 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11295 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11296
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011297 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11298 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11299 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11300 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11301 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11302
11303 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11304 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11305 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011306 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11307 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011308 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11309 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011310
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011311shutdown frontend <frontend>
11312 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11313 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11314 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11315 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11316 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11317 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11318 once it is terminated.
11319
11320 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11321 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11322
11323 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11324 level "admin".
11325
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011326shutdown session <id>
11327 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11328 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11329 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11330 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11331 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11332 flag in the logs.
11333
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011334shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11335 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11336 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11337 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11338 'K' flag in the logs.
11339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011340/*
11341 * Local variables:
11342 * fill-column: 79
11343 * End:
11344 */